1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files. 2 % 3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex. 4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi 5 % 6 \def\texinfoversion{2006-02-13.16} 7 % 8 % Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free 10 % Software Foundation, Inc. 11 % 12 % This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or 13 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as 14 % published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at 15 % your option) any later version. 16 % 17 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be 18 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty 19 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU 20 % General Public License for more details. 21 % 22 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License 23 % along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write 24 % to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, 25 % Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. 26 % 27 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing 28 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without 29 % restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.) 30 % 31 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug 32 % reports; you can get the latest version from: 33 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or 34 % ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex 35 % (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org). 36 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out 37 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check. 38 % 39 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo (a] gnu.org. Please include including a 40 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the 41 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated. 42 % 43 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the 44 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple 45 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this: 46 % tex foo.texi 47 % texindex foo.?? 48 % tex foo.texi 49 % tex foo.texi 50 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps. 51 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct. 52 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more 53 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary. 54 % 55 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some 56 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the 57 % full Texinfo distribution. 58 % 59 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo. 60 61 62 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:} 63 64 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number 65 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because 66 % they might have appeared in the input file name. 67 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}% 68 \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active} 69 70 \message{Basics,} 71 \chardef\other=12 72 73 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo. 74 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign. 75 \let\+ = \relax 76 77 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine. 78 \let\ptexb=\b 79 \let\ptexbullet=\bullet 80 \let\ptexc=\c 81 \let\ptexcomma=\, 82 \let\ptexdot=\. 83 \let\ptexdots=\dots 84 \let\ptexend=\end 85 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv 86 \let\ptexexclam=\! 87 \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote 88 \let\ptexgtr=> 89 \let\ptexhat=^ 90 \let\ptexi=\i 91 \let\ptexindent=\indent 92 \let\ptexinsert=\insert 93 \let\ptexlbrace=\{ 94 \let\ptexless=< 95 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite 96 \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent 97 \let\ptexplus=+ 98 \let\ptexrbrace=\} 99 \let\ptexslash=\/ 100 \let\ptexstar=\* 101 \let\ptext=\t 102 103 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it 104 % starts a new line in the output. 105 \newlinechar = `^^J 106 107 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error 108 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. 109 % 110 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined 111 \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0. 112 \else 113 \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space} 114 \fi 115 116 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set. 117 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi 118 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi 119 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi 120 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi 121 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi 122 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi 123 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi 124 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi 125 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi 126 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi 127 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi 128 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi 129 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi 130 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi 131 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi 132 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi 133 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi 134 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi 135 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi 136 % 137 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi 138 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi 139 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi 140 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi 141 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi 142 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi 143 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi 144 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi 145 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi 146 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi 147 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi 148 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi 149 % 150 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi 151 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi 152 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi 153 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi 154 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi 155 156 % Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful. 157 \chardef\spacecat = 10 158 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat} 159 160 % Ignore a token. 161 % 162 \def\gobble#1{} 163 164 % The following is used inside several \edef's. 165 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname} 166 167 % Hyphenation fixes. 168 \hyphenation{ 169 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script 170 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps 171 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script 172 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm 173 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces 174 spell-ing spell-ings 175 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space 176 wide-spread wrap-around 177 } 178 179 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages. 180 \newdimen\bindingoffset 181 \newdimen\normaloffset 182 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight 183 184 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles 185 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided 186 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin). 187 % 188 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt} 189 190 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should 191 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the 192 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would 193 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main 194 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change). 195 % 196 \def\|{% 197 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode. 198 \leavevmode 199 % 200 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output. 201 \vadjust{% 202 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current 203 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record. 204 \vskip-\baselineskip 205 % 206 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So 207 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin. 208 \llap{% 209 % 210 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'. 211 \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt 212 % 213 % This is the space between the bar and the text. 214 \hskip 12pt 215 }% 216 }% 217 } 218 219 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file 220 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here, 221 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make 222 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log 223 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX. 224 % 225 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}% 226 \def\loggingall{% 227 \tracingstats2 228 \tracingpages1 229 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex 230 \tracingparagraphs1 231 \tracingoutput1 232 \tracingmacros2 233 \tracingrestores1 234 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen 235 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging 236 \tracingscantokens1 237 \tracingifs1 238 \tracinggroups1 239 \tracingnesting2 240 \tracingassigns1 241 \fi 242 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex 243 \errorcontextlines16 244 }% 245 246 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing 247 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space. 248 % 249 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount 250 \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi} 251 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount 252 \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi} 253 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount 254 \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi} 255 256 % For @cropmarks command. 257 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks. 258 % 259 \newif\ifcropmarks 260 \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue 261 % 262 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners. 263 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986 264 % 265 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines 266 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc 267 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt 268 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in 269 270 % Main output routine. 271 \chardef\PAGE = 255 272 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}} 273 274 \newbox\headlinebox 275 \newbox\footlinebox 276 277 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents 278 % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself. 279 \def\onepageout#1{% 280 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi 281 % 282 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset 283 \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi 284 % 285 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in 286 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code). 287 \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}% 288 \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}% 289 % 290 {% 291 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to 292 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends 293 % before the \shipout runs. 294 % 295 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output. 296 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if 297 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example. 298 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this: 299 % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}} 300 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in; 301 % it needs to be 302 % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym} 303 \shipout\vbox{% 304 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page. 305 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi 306 % 307 \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup 308 \hsize = \outerhsize 309 \vskip-\topandbottommargin 310 \vtop to0pt{% 311 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}% 312 \nointerlineskip 313 \line{% 314 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}% 315 \hfill 316 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}% 317 }% 318 \vss}% 319 \vskip\topandbottommargin 320 \line\bgroup 321 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize. 322 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi 323 \vbox\bgroup 324 \fi 325 % 326 \unvbox\headlinebox 327 \pagebody{#1}% 328 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt 329 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty. 330 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingxxx.) 331 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect. 332 \vskip 2\baselineskip 333 \unvbox\footlinebox 334 \fi 335 % 336 \ifcropmarks 337 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup 338 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup 339 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill 340 \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick 341 \vbox to0pt{\vss 342 \line{% 343 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}% 344 \hfill 345 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}% 346 }% 347 \nointerlineskip 348 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}% 349 }% 350 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause 351 \fi 352 }% end of \shipout\vbox 353 }% end of group with \indexdummies 354 \advancepageno 355 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi 356 } 357 358 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen 359 360 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}} 361 {\catcode`\@ =11 362 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi 363 % marginal hacks, juha (a] viisa.uucp (Juha Takala) 364 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present 365 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi 366 \dimen@=\dp#1 \unvbox#1 367 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi 368 \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi} 369 } 370 371 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are 372 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize 373 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986) 374 % 375 \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong} 376 \def\nstop{\vbox 377 {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}} 378 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong} 379 \def\nsbot{\vbox 380 {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}} 381 382 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of 383 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a 384 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument. 385 % 386 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}} 387 \def\parseargusing#1#2{% 388 \def\next{#2}% 389 \begingroup 390 \obeylines 391 \spaceisspace 392 #1% 393 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below. 394 } 395 396 {\obeylines % 397 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{% 398 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg. 399 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm% 400 }% 401 } 402 403 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment. 404 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm} 405 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm} 406 407 % Each occurence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space. 408 % 409 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g., 410 % @end itemize @c foo 411 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed 412 % by \finishparsearg. 413 % 414 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M} 415 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M} 416 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{% 417 \def\temp{#3}% 418 \ifx\temp\empty 419 % We cannot use \next here, as it holds the macro to run; 420 % thus we reuse \temp. 421 \let\temp\finishparsearg 422 \else 423 \let\temp\argcheckspaces 424 \fi 425 % Put the space token in: 426 \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm 427 } 428 429 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so 430 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation. 431 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now, 432 % just before passing the control to \next. 433 % (Similarily, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is 434 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger 435 % that a pair of braces would be stripped. 436 % 437 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token. 438 % 439 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\next\expandafter{#1}} 440 441 % \parseargdef\foo{...} 442 % is roughly equivalent to 443 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo} 444 % \def\Xfoo#1{...} 445 % 446 % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my 447 % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03 448 449 \def\parseargdef#1{% 450 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1% 451 } 452 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{% 453 \def#2{\parsearg#1}% 454 \def#1##1% 455 } 456 457 % Several utility definitions with active space: 458 { 459 \obeyspaces 460 \gdef\obeyedspace{ } 461 462 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword 463 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this 464 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input 465 % should produce a line of output anyway. 466 % 467 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie} 468 469 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces 470 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the 471 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ). 472 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space} 473 } 474 475 476 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next} 477 478 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this: 479 % 480 % \envdef\foo{...} 481 % \def\Efoo{...} 482 % 483 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the 484 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also 485 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks 486 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be 487 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected. 488 % 489 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they 490 % are not treated as enviroments; they don't open a group. (The 491 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this 492 % special case.) 493 494 495 % At runtime, environments start with this: 496 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}} 497 % initialize 498 \let\thisenv\empty 499 500 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'': 501 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}} 502 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}} 503 504 % Check whether we're in the right environment: 505 \def\checkenv#1{% 506 \def\temp{#1}% 507 \ifx\thisenv\temp 508 \else 509 \badenverr 510 \fi 511 } 512 513 % Evironment mismatch, #1 expected: 514 \def\badenverr{% 515 \errhelp = \EMsimple 516 \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp, 517 not \inenvironment\thisenv}% 518 } 519 \def\inenvironment#1{% 520 \ifx#1\empty 521 out of any environment% 522 \else 523 in environment \expandafter\string#1% 524 \fi 525 } 526 527 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo. 528 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv 529 % 530 \parseargdef\end{% 531 \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname 532 \else 533 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03 534 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname 535 \csname E#1\endcsname 536 \endgroup 537 \fi 538 } 539 540 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.} 541 542 543 %% Simple single-character @ commands 544 545 % @@ prints an @ 546 % Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr). 547 \def\@{{\tt\char64}} 548 549 % This is turned off because it was never documented 550 % and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures. 551 %% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and ' 552 %% but suppressing ligatures. 553 %\def\`{{`}} 554 %\def\'{{'}} 555 556 % Used to generate quoted braces. 557 \def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}} 558 \def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}} 559 \let\{=\mylbrace 560 \let\}=\myrbrace 561 \begingroup 562 % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices, 563 % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files. 564 \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other 565 \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2 566 \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other 567 !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]% 568 !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]% 569 !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]% 570 !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]% 571 !endgroup 572 573 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems. 574 \let\comma = , 575 576 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent 577 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H. 578 \let\, = \c 579 \let\dotaccent = \. 580 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}} 581 \let\tieaccent = \t 582 \let\ubaraccent = \b 583 \let\udotaccent = \d 584 585 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm 586 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss. 587 \def\questiondown{?`} 588 \def\exclamdown{!`} 589 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}} 590 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}} 591 592 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents. 593 \def\imacro{i} 594 \def\jmacro{j} 595 \def\dotless#1{% 596 \def\temp{#1}% 597 \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi 598 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j 599 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}% 600 \fi\fi 601 } 602 603 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a 604 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.) 605 % 606 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 } 607 608 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in 609 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most 610 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using 611 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and 612 % \scriptscriptstyle). 613 % 614 \def\LaTeX{% 615 L\kern-.36em 616 {\setbox0=\hbox{T}% 617 \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A}\vss}}% 618 \kern-.15em 619 \TeX 620 } 621 622 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space 623 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space 624 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and 625 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the 626 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph. 627 {\catcode`@ = 11 628 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble 629 % if the definition is written into an index file. 630 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M 631 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ } 632 } 633 634 % @: forces normal size whitespace following. 635 \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 } 636 637 % @* forces a line break. 638 \def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces} 639 640 % @/ allows a line break. 641 \let\/=\allowbreak 642 643 % @. is an end-of-sentence period. 644 \def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space} 645 646 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang. 647 \def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space} 648 649 % @? is an end-of-sentence query. 650 \def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space} 651 652 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation. 653 % 654 \def\onword{on} 655 \def\offword{off} 656 % 657 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{% 658 \def\temp{#1}% 659 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing 660 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing 661 \else 662 \errhelp = \EMsimple 663 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on/off}% 664 \fi\fi 665 } 666 667 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the 668 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would 669 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph. 670 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}} 671 672 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing 673 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box 674 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for 675 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is 676 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large, 677 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and 678 % the text is small, which looks bad. 679 % 680 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can 681 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it 682 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an 683 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The 684 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit 685 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex). 686 % 687 \newbox\groupbox 688 \def\vfilllimit{0.7} 689 % 690 \envdef\group{% 691 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else 692 \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp 693 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}% 694 \fi 695 \startsavinginserts 696 % 697 \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup 698 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as 699 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an 700 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after 701 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group 702 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo 703 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text. 704 \comment 705 } 706 % 707 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts 708 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done) 709 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space 710 % above. But it's pretty close. 711 \def\Egroup{% 712 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group 713 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth. 714 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar. 715 \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth 716 \egroup % End the \vtop. 717 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box. 718 \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox 719 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less). 720 \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal 721 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big 722 % group, force a page break. 723 \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2 724 \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight 725 \page 726 \fi 727 \fi 728 \box\groupbox 729 \prevdepth = \dimen1 730 \checkinserts 731 } 732 % 733 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help 734 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'. 735 % 736 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{% 737 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J% 738 where each line of input produces a line of output.} 739 740 % @need space-in-mils 741 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining. 742 743 \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in 744 745 % Old definition--didn't work. 746 %\parseargdef\need{\par % 747 %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally 748 %% if the depth of the box does not fit. 749 %{\baselineskip=0pt% 750 %\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak 751 %\prevdepth=-1000pt 752 %}} 753 754 \parseargdef\need{% 755 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a 756 % paragraph. 757 \par 758 % 759 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless. 760 \dimen0 = #1\mil 761 \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox 762 \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox 763 \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2 764 % 765 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the 766 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line. 767 % And a page break here is fine. 768 \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}% 769 % 770 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the 771 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the 772 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider 773 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the 774 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999. 775 % 776 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the 777 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in 778 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which 779 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing 780 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an 781 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real 782 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy. 783 \penalty9999 784 % 785 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not. 786 \kern -#1\mil 787 % 788 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern. 789 \nobreak 790 \fi 791 } 792 793 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented). 794 795 \let\br = \par 796 797 % @page forces the start of a new page. 798 % 799 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject} 800 801 % @exdent text.... 802 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin 803 804 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment. 805 % That's how much \exdent should take out. 806 \newskip\exdentamount 807 808 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun. 809 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break} 810 811 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example. 812 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount 813 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}} 814 815 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current 816 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion 817 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. 818 % 819 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm 820 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox} 821 % 822 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{% 823 \nobreak 824 \kern-\strutdepth 825 \vtop to \strutdepth{% 826 \baselineskip=\strutdepth 827 \vss 828 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to 829 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size. 830 \ifx#1l% 831 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}% 832 \else 833 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}% 834 \fi 835 \null 836 }% 837 }} 838 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l} 839 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r} 840 % 841 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]} 842 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right; 843 % else use TEXT for both). 844 % 845 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish} 846 \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing. 847 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% 848 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt 849 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts 850 \def\righttext{#2}% 851 \else 852 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text 853 \def\righttext{#1}% 854 \fi 855 % 856 \ifodd\pageno 857 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin 858 \else 859 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}% 860 \fi 861 \temp 862 } 863 864 % @include file insert text of that file as input. 865 % 866 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz} 867 \def\includezzz#1{% 868 \pushthisfilestack 869 \def\thisfile{#1}% 870 {% 871 \makevalueexpandable 872 \def\temp{\input #1 }% 873 \expandafter 874 }\temp 875 \popthisfilestack 876 } 877 \def\filenamecatcodes{% 878 \catcode`\\=\other 879 \catcode`~=\other 880 \catcode`^=\other 881 \catcode`_=\other 882 \catcode`|=\other 883 \catcode`<=\other 884 \catcode`>=\other 885 \catcode`+=\other 886 \catcode`-=\other 887 } 888 889 \def\pushthisfilestack{% 890 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm 891 } 892 \def\pushthisfilestackX{% 893 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm 894 } 895 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {% 896 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}% 897 } 898 899 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty} 900 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error: 901 the stack of filenames is empty.}} 902 903 \def\thisfile{} 904 905 % @center line 906 % outputs that line, centered. 907 % 908 \parseargdef\center{% 909 \ifhmode 910 \let\next\centerH 911 \else 912 \let\next\centerV 913 \fi 914 \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}% 915 } 916 \def\centerH#1{% 917 {% 918 \hfil\break 919 \advance\hsize by -\leftskip 920 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip 921 \line{#1}% 922 \break 923 }% 924 } 925 \def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}} 926 927 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space 928 929 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip} 930 931 % @comment ...line which is ignored... 932 % @c is the same as @comment 933 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment 934 935 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other% 936 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other% 937 \commentxxx} 938 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}} 939 940 \let\c=\comment 941 942 % @paragraphindent NCHARS 943 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough. 944 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'. 945 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though. 946 % 947 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords 948 \def\noneword{none} 949 % 950 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{% 951 \def\temp{#1}% 952 \ifx\temp\asisword 953 \else 954 \ifx\temp\noneword 955 \defaultparindent = 0pt 956 \else 957 \defaultparindent = #1em 958 \fi 959 \fi 960 \parindent = \defaultparindent 961 } 962 963 % @exampleindent NCHARS 964 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent. 965 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but 966 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent. 967 \parseargdef\exampleindent{% 968 \def\temp{#1}% 969 \ifx\temp\asisword 970 \else 971 \ifx\temp\noneword 972 \lispnarrowing = 0pt 973 \else 974 \lispnarrowing = #1em 975 \fi 976 \fi 977 } 978 979 % @firstparagraphindent WORD 980 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph 981 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such 982 % paragraphs. 983 % 984 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling 985 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do. 986 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD. 987 % By default, we suppress indentation. 988 % 989 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent} 990 \def\insertword{insert} 991 % 992 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{% 993 \def\temp{#1}% 994 \ifx\temp\noneword 995 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent 996 \else\ifx\temp\insertword 997 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax 998 \else 999 \errhelp = \EMsimple 1000 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}% 1001 \fi\fi 1002 } 1003 1004 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to 1005 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty. 1006 % 1007 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next 1008 % paragraph. 1009 % 1010 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{% 1011 \gdef\indent{% 1012 \restorefirstparagraphindent 1013 \indent 1014 }% 1015 \gdef\noindent{% 1016 \restorefirstparagraphindent 1017 \noindent 1018 }% 1019 \global\everypar = {% 1020 \kern -\parindent 1021 \restorefirstparagraphindent 1022 }% 1023 } 1024 1025 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{% 1026 \global \let \indent = \ptexindent 1027 \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent 1028 \global \everypar = {}% 1029 } 1030 1031 1032 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example. 1033 % 1034 \def\asis#1{#1} 1035 1036 % @math outputs its argument in math mode. 1037 % 1038 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean 1039 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make 1040 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam, 1041 % which is what @var uses. 1042 { 1043 \catcode`\_ = \active 1044 \gdef\mathunderscore{% 1045 \catcode`\_=\active 1046 \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}% 1047 } 1048 } 1049 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character. 1050 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but 1051 % this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not 1052 % otherwise define @\. 1053 % 1054 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\. 1055 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi} 1056 % 1057 \def\math{% 1058 \tex 1059 \mathunderscore 1060 \let\\ = \mathbackslash 1061 \mathactive 1062 $\finishmath 1063 } 1064 \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex. 1065 1066 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math. 1067 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument 1068 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section). 1069 % 1070 { 1071 \catcode`^ = \active 1072 \catcode`< = \active 1073 \catcode`> = \active 1074 \catcode`+ = \active 1075 \gdef\mathactive{% 1076 \let^ = \ptexhat 1077 \let< = \ptexless 1078 \let> = \ptexgtr 1079 \let+ = \ptexplus 1080 } 1081 } 1082 1083 % @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above. 1084 \def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$} 1085 \def\minus{$-$} 1086 1087 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font. 1088 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in a typewriter 1089 % font as three actual period characters. 1090 % 1091 \def\dots{% 1092 \leavevmode 1093 \hbox to 1.5em{% 1094 \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil 1095 .\hfil.\hfil.% 1096 \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil 1097 }% 1098 } 1099 1100 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis. 1101 % 1102 \def\enddots{% 1103 \dots 1104 \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor 1105 } 1106 1107 % @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up 1108 % Texinfo's parsing. 1109 % 1110 \let\comma = , 1111 1112 % @refill is a no-op. 1113 \let\refill=\relax 1114 1115 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to 1116 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs. 1117 % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename). 1118 % 1119 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files. 1120 \let\novalidate = \linksfalse 1121 1122 % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file. 1123 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input. 1124 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo. 1125 \def\setfilename{% 1126 \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'. 1127 \iflinks 1128 \tryauxfile 1129 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit. 1130 \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux 1131 \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case. 1132 \openindices 1133 \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds. 1134 % 1135 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it. 1136 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. 1137 \openin 1 texinfo.cnf 1138 \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi 1139 \closein 1 1140 % 1141 \comment % Ignore the actual filename. 1142 } 1143 1144 % Called from \setfilename. 1145 % 1146 \def\openindices{% 1147 \newindex{cp}% 1148 \newcodeindex{fn}% 1149 \newcodeindex{vr}% 1150 \newcodeindex{tp}% 1151 \newcodeindex{ky}% 1152 \newcodeindex{pg}% 1153 } 1154 1155 % @bye. 1156 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend} 1157 1158 1159 \message{pdf,} 1160 % adobe `portable' document format 1161 \newcount\tempnum 1162 \newcount\lnkcount 1163 \newtoks\filename 1164 \newcount\filenamelength 1165 \newcount\pgn 1166 \newtoks\toksA 1167 \newtoks\toksB 1168 \newtoks\toksC 1169 \newtoks\toksD 1170 \newbox\boxA 1171 \newcount\countA 1172 \newif\ifpdf 1173 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest 1174 1175 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1 1176 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined, 1177 % borrowed from ifpdf.sty. 1178 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined 1179 \else 1180 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax 1181 \else 1182 \ifcase\pdfoutput 1183 \else 1184 \pdftrue 1185 \fi 1186 \fi 1187 \fi 1188 1189 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets, 1190 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to 1191 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be 1192 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good. 1193 % http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html 1194 % (and related messages, the final outcome is that it is up to the TeX 1195 % user to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so 1196 % that's what we do). 1197 1198 % double active backslashes. 1199 % 1200 {\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active 1201 @gdef@activebackslashdouble{% 1202 @catcode`@\=@active 1203 @let\=@doublebackslash} 1204 } 1205 1206 % To handle parens, we must adopt a different approach, since parens are 1207 % not active characters. hyperref.dtx (which has the same problem as 1208 % us) handles it with this amazing macro to replace tokens. I've 1209 % tinkered with it a little for texinfo, but it's definitely from there. 1210 % 1211 % #1 is the tokens to replace. 1212 % #2 is the replacement. 1213 % #3 is the control sequence with the string. 1214 % 1215 \def\HyPsdSubst#1#2#3{% 1216 \def\HyPsdReplace##1#1##2\END{% 1217 ##1% 1218 \ifx\\##2\\% 1219 \else 1220 #2% 1221 \HyReturnAfterFi{% 1222 \HyPsdReplace##2\END 1223 }% 1224 \fi 1225 }% 1226 \xdef#3{\expandafter\HyPsdReplace#3#1\END}% 1227 } 1228 \long\def\HyReturnAfterFi#1\fi{\fi#1} 1229 1230 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements. 1231 \def\backslashparens#1{% 1232 \xdef#1{#1}% redefine it as its expansion; the definition is simply 1233 % \lastnode when called from \setref -> \pdfmkdest. 1234 \HyPsdSubst{(}{\realbackslash(}{#1}% 1235 \HyPsdSubst{)}{\realbackslash)}{#1}% 1236 } 1237 1238 \ifpdf 1239 \input pdfcolor 1240 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}% 1241 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{% 1242 \def\imagewidth{#2}% 1243 \def\imageheight{#3}% 1244 % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is 1245 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.) 1246 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 1247 \immediate\pdfimage 1248 \else 1249 \immediate\pdfximage 1250 \fi 1251 \ifx\empty\imagewidth\else width \imagewidth \fi 1252 \ifx\empty\imageheight\else height \imageheight \fi 1253 \ifnum\pdftexversion<13 1254 #1.pdf% 1255 \else 1256 {#1.pdf}% 1257 \fi 1258 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else 1259 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage 1260 \fi} 1261 \def\pdfmkdest#1{{% 1262 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters 1263 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title. 1264 \atdummies 1265 \activebackslashdouble 1266 \def\pdfdestname{#1}% 1267 \backslashparens\pdfdestname 1268 \pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz% 1269 }}% 1270 % 1271 % used to mark target names; must be expandable. 1272 \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}% 1273 % 1274 \let\linkcolor = \Blue % was Cyan, but that seems light? 1275 \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink} 1276 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines 1277 % come from Petr Olsak 1278 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0% 1279 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi} 1280 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax 1281 \advance\tempnum by 1 1282 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}} 1283 % 1284 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the 1285 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number 1286 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text, 1287 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node. 1288 % #4 is the page number 1289 % 1290 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{% 1291 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the 1292 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section 1293 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't 1294 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured. 1295 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}% 1296 \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty 1297 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}% 1298 \else 1299 % Doubled backslashes in the name. 1300 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}% 1301 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinedest}% 1302 \fi 1303 % 1304 % Also double the backslashes in the display string. 1305 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}% 1306 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinetext}% 1307 % 1308 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}% 1309 } 1310 % 1311 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{% 1312 \begingroup 1313 % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks 1314 \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace 1315 \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace 1316 % 1317 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline. 1318 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{% 1319 \def\thischapnum{##2}% 1320 \def\thissecnum{0}% 1321 \def\thissubsecnum{0}% 1322 }% 1323 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% 1324 \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}% 1325 \def\thissecnum{##2}% 1326 \def\thissubsecnum{0}% 1327 }% 1328 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% 1329 \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}% 1330 \def\thissubsecnum{##2}% 1331 }% 1332 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% 1333 \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}% 1334 }% 1335 \def\thischapnum{0}% 1336 \def\thissecnum{0}% 1337 \def\thissubsecnum{0}% 1338 % 1339 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et 1340 % al. a second time, below. 1341 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}% 1342 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}% 1343 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% 1344 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% 1345 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}% 1346 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}% 1347 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% 1348 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% 1349 \readdatafile{toc}% 1350 % 1351 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines. 1352 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of 1353 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above. 1354 % 1355 % We use the node names as the destinations. 1356 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{% 1357 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}% 1358 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% 1359 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% 1360 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% 1361 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% 1362 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero 1363 \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}% 1364 % 1365 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of 1366 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters, 1367 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from 1368 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from 1369 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100. 1370 % 1371 % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to 1372 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right 1373 % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way. 1374 \indexnofonts 1375 \setupdatafile 1376 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash 1377 \input \jobname.toc 1378 \endgroup 1379 } 1380 % 1381 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}% 1382 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax 1383 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces 1384 \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}% 1385 \advance\filenamelength by 1 1386 \fi 1387 \fi 1388 \nextsp} 1389 \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax} 1390 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 1391 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink 1392 \else 1393 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink 1394 \fi 1395 % make a live url in pdf output. 1396 \def\pdfurl#1{% 1397 \begingroup 1398 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not 1399 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context 1400 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one 1401 % people have actually reported a problem with. 1402 % 1403 \normalturnoffactive 1404 \def\@{@}% 1405 \let\/=\empty 1406 \makevalueexpandable 1407 \leavevmode\Red 1408 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% 1409 user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}% 1410 \endgroup} 1411 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}} 1412 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} 1413 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks} 1414 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}} 1415 \def\maketoks{% 1416 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax 1417 \ifx\first0\adn0 1418 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3 1419 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6 1420 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9 1421 \else 1422 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi 1423 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else 1424 \let\next=\maketoks 1425 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD} 1426 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi 1427 \fi 1428 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi 1429 \next} 1430 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}% 1431 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0} 1432 \def\pdflink#1{% 1433 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}} 1434 \linkcolor #1\endlink} 1435 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st} 1436 \else 1437 \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble 1438 \let\pdfurl = \gobble 1439 \let\endlink = \relax 1440 \let\linkcolor = \relax 1441 \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax 1442 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput 1443 1444 1445 \message{fonts,} 1446 1447 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle. 1448 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in 1449 % italics, not bold italics. 1450 % 1451 \def\setfontstyle#1{% 1452 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd. 1453 \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font 1454 } 1455 1456 % Select #1 fonts with the current style. 1457 % 1458 \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname} 1459 1460 \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}} 1461 \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}} 1462 \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}} 1463 \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf} 1464 \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}} 1465 1466 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not. 1467 % So we set up a \sf. 1468 \newfam\sffam 1469 \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}} 1470 \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf. 1471 1472 % We don't need math for this font style. 1473 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}} 1474 1475 % Default leading. 1476 \newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt 1477 1478 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size 1479 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers 1480 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined. 1481 % 1482 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333} 1483 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833} 1484 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167} 1485 % 1486 \def\setleading#1{% 1487 \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax 1488 \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip 1489 \normalbaselines 1490 \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{% 1491 \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip 1492 depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip 1493 }% 1494 } 1495 1496 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the 1497 % specified font prefix (normally `cm'). 1498 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor 1499 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4{\font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4} 1500 1501 % Use cm as the default font prefix. 1502 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix 1503 % before you read in texinfo.tex. 1504 \ifx\fontprefix\undefined 1505 \def\fontprefix{cm} 1506 \fi 1507 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM. 1508 \def\rmshape{r} 1509 \def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold 1510 \def\bfshape{b} 1511 \def\bxshape{bx} 1512 \def\ttshape{tt} 1513 \def\ttbshape{tt} 1514 \def\ttslshape{sltt} 1515 \def\itshape{ti} 1516 \def\itbshape{bxti} 1517 \def\slshape{sl} 1518 \def\slbshape{bxsl} 1519 \def\sfshape{ss} 1520 \def\sfbshape{ss} 1521 \def\scshape{csc} 1522 \def\scbshape{csc} 1523 1524 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1). 1525 \def\textnominalsize{11pt} 1526 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf} 1527 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep} 1528 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep} 1529 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep} 1530 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep} 1531 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep} 1532 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep} 1533 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep} 1534 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep} 1535 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep 1536 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep 1537 1538 % A few fonts for @defun names and args. 1539 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1} 1540 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1} 1541 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1} 1542 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf} 1543 1544 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt). 1545 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt} 1546 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000} 1547 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000} 1548 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900} 1549 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000} 1550 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000} 1551 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000} 1552 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900} 1553 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900} 1554 \font\smalli=cmmi9 1555 \font\smallsy=cmsy9 1556 1557 % Fonts for small examples (8pt). 1558 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt} 1559 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000} 1560 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000} 1561 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800} 1562 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000} 1563 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000} 1564 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000} 1565 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800} 1566 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800} 1567 \font\smalleri=cmmi8 1568 \font\smallersy=cmsy8 1569 1570 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt): 1571 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt} 1572 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3} 1573 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4} 1574 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4} 1575 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3} 1576 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4} 1577 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1} 1578 \let\titlebf=\titlerm 1579 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4} 1580 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3 1581 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4 1582 \def\authorrm{\secrm} 1583 \def\authortt{\sectt} 1584 1585 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt). 1586 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt} 1587 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2} 1588 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3} 1589 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3} 1590 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2} 1591 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3} 1592 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000} 1593 \let\chapbf=\chaprm 1594 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3} 1595 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2 1596 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3 1597 1598 % Section fonts (14.4pt). 1599 \def\secnominalsize{14pt} 1600 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1} 1601 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2} 1602 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2} 1603 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1} 1604 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2} 1605 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1} 1606 \let\secbf\secrm 1607 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2} 1608 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1 1609 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2 1610 1611 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt). 1612 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt} 1613 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf} 1614 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315} 1615 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315} 1616 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf} 1617 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315} 1618 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf} 1619 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm 1620 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315} 1621 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf 1622 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315 1623 1624 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt). 1625 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt} 1626 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000} 1627 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000} 1628 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000} 1629 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000} 1630 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000} 1631 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000} 1632 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000} 1633 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000} 1634 \font\reducedi=cmmi10 1635 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10 1636 1637 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters, 1638 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since 1639 % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except 1640 % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and 1641 % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts). 1642 % 1643 \def\resetmathfonts{% 1644 \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy 1645 \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf 1646 \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf 1647 } 1648 1649 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead 1650 % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the 1651 % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire 1652 % \tenSTYLE to set the current font. 1653 % 1654 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower) 1655 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in 1656 % the LaTeX logo and acronyms. 1657 % 1658 % This all needs generalizing, badly. 1659 % 1660 \def\textfonts{% 1661 \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl 1662 \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc 1663 \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy 1664 \let\tenttsl=\textttsl 1665 \def\curfontsize{text}% 1666 \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}% 1667 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}} 1668 \def\titlefonts{% 1669 \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl 1670 \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc 1671 \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy 1672 \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl 1673 \def\curfontsize{title}% 1674 \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}% 1675 \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}} 1676 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}} 1677 \def\chapfonts{% 1678 \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl 1679 \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc 1680 \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy 1681 \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl 1682 \def\curfontsize{chap}% 1683 \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}% 1684 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}} 1685 \def\secfonts{% 1686 \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl 1687 \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc 1688 \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy 1689 \let\tenttsl=\secttsl 1690 \def\curfontsize{sec}% 1691 \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}% 1692 \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}} 1693 \def\subsecfonts{% 1694 \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl 1695 \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc 1696 \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy 1697 \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl 1698 \def\curfontsize{ssec}% 1699 \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}% 1700 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}} 1701 \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts 1702 \def\reducedfonts{% 1703 \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl 1704 \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc 1705 \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy 1706 \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl 1707 \def\curfontsize{reduced}% 1708 \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}% 1709 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} 1710 \def\smallfonts{% 1711 \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl 1712 \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc 1713 \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy 1714 \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl 1715 \def\curfontsize{small}% 1716 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}% 1717 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} 1718 \def\smallerfonts{% 1719 \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl 1720 \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc 1721 \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy 1722 \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl 1723 \def\curfontsize{smaller}% 1724 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}% 1725 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}} 1726 1727 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments. 1728 \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts 1729 1730 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample 1731 % can fit this many characters: 1732 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69 1733 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters: 1734 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77 1735 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth 1736 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt. 1737 % 1738 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt): 1739 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58 1740 % 1741 % I wish the USA used A4 paper. 1742 % --karl, 24jan03. 1743 1744 1745 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes. 1746 % 1747 \textfonts \rm 1748 1749 % Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts. 1750 \def\angleleft{$\langle$} 1751 \def\angleright{$\rangle$} 1752 1753 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks 1754 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0 1755 1756 % Fonts for short table of contents. 1757 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000} 1758 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1} % no cmb12 1759 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000} 1760 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000} 1761 1762 %% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans 1763 %% serif) and @ii for TeX italic 1764 1765 % \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction 1766 % unless the following character is such as not to need one. 1767 \def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else 1768 \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi} 1769 \def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} 1770 \def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} 1771 1772 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl. 1773 % @var is set to this for defun arguments. 1774 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} 1775 1776 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want 1777 % ttsl for book titles, do we? 1778 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} 1779 1780 \let\i=\smartitalic 1781 \let\slanted=\smartslanted 1782 \let\var=\smartslanted 1783 \let\dfn=\smartslanted 1784 \let\emph=\smartitalic 1785 1786 % @b, explicit bold. 1787 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}} 1788 \let\strong=\b 1789 1790 % @sansserif, explicit sans. 1791 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}} 1792 1793 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at 1794 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the 1795 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called. 1796 % 1797 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation} 1798 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- } 1799 1800 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value. 1801 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and 1802 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up. 1803 % 1804 \chardef\colonChar = `\: 1805 \chardef\commaChar = `\, 1806 \chardef\dotChar = `\. 1807 \chardef\exclamChar= `\! 1808 \chardef\questChar = `\? 1809 \chardef\semiChar = `\; 1810 % 1811 \catcode`@=11 1812 \def\plainfrenchspacing{% 1813 \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m 1814 \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m 1815 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends 1816 } 1817 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{% 1818 \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000 1819 \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250 1820 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends 1821 } 1822 \catcode`@=\other 1823 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default 1824 1825 \def\t#1{% 1826 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}% 1827 \null 1828 } 1829 \def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null} 1830 \setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000} 1831 \font\keysy=cmsy9 1832 \def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{% 1833 \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{% 1834 \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt 1835 \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}% 1836 \kern-0.4pt\hrule}% 1837 \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}} 1838 % The old definition, with no lozenge: 1839 %\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null} 1840 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1} 1841 1842 % @file, @option are the same as @samp. 1843 \let\file=\samp 1844 \let\option=\samp 1845 1846 % @code is a modification of @t, 1847 % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text. 1848 \def\tclose#1{% 1849 {% 1850 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font. 1851 \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font 1852 % 1853 % Switch to typewriter. 1854 \tt 1855 % 1856 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space. 1857 \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}% 1858 % 1859 % Turn off hyphenation. 1860 \nohyphenation 1861 % 1862 \rawbackslash 1863 \plainfrenchspacing 1864 #1% 1865 }% 1866 \null 1867 } 1868 1869 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code. 1870 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes 1871 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc. 1872 1873 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control 1874 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words. 1875 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that) 1876 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. 1877 % -- rms. 1878 { 1879 \catcode`\-=\active 1880 \catcode`\_=\active 1881 % 1882 \global\def\code{\begingroup 1883 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active 1884 \ifallowcodebreaks 1885 \let-\codedash 1886 \let_\codeunder 1887 \else 1888 \let-\realdash 1889 \let_\realunder 1890 \fi 1891 \codex 1892 } 1893 } 1894 1895 \def\realdash{-} 1896 \def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}} 1897 \def\codeunder{% 1898 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _ 1899 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.) 1900 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us 1901 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop. 1902 \ifusingtt{\ifmmode 1903 \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_. 1904 \else\normalunderscore \fi 1905 \discretionary{}{}{}}% 1906 {\_}% 1907 } 1908 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup} 1909 1910 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g., 1911 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is undesirable in 1912 % some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in 1913 % general. @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this. 1914 % 1915 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue 1916 1917 \def\keywordtrue{true} 1918 \def\keywordfalse{false} 1919 1920 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{% 1921 \def\txiarg{#1}% 1922 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue 1923 \allowcodebreakstrue 1924 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse 1925 \allowcodebreaksfalse 1926 \else 1927 \errhelp = \EMsimple 1928 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg'}% 1929 \fi\fi 1930 } 1931 1932 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command, 1933 % then @kbd has no effect. 1934 1935 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always), 1936 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends), 1937 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always). 1938 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{% 1939 \def\txiarg{#1}% 1940 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct 1941 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}% 1942 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample 1943 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% 1944 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode 1945 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% 1946 \else 1947 \errhelp = \EMsimple 1948 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\txiarg'}% 1949 \fi\fi\fi 1950 } 1951 \def\worddistinct{distinct} 1952 \def\wordexample{example} 1953 \def\wordcode{code} 1954 1955 % Default is `distinct.' 1956 \kbdinputstyle distinct 1957 1958 \def\xkey{\key} 1959 \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}% 1960 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}% 1961 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi 1962 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi} 1963 1964 % For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code. 1965 \let\indicateurl=\code 1966 \let\env=\code 1967 \let\command=\code 1968 1969 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated) 1970 % second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third 1971 % arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url 1972 % itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in 1973 % a hypertex \special here. 1974 % 1975 \def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish} 1976 \def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup 1977 \unsepspaces 1978 \pdfurl{#1}% 1979 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% 1980 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt 1981 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that 1982 \else 1983 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% 1984 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt 1985 \ifpdf 1986 \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it 1987 \else 1988 \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url 1989 \fi 1990 \else 1991 \code{#1}% only url given, so show it 1992 \fi 1993 \fi 1994 \endlink 1995 \endgroup} 1996 1997 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it. 1998 % 1999 \let\url=\uref 2000 2001 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97. 2002 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf. 2003 % 2004 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright} 2005 \ifpdf 2006 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish} 2007 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup 2008 \unsepspaces 2009 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}% 2010 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% 2011 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi 2012 \endlink 2013 \endgroup} 2014 \else 2015 \let\email=\uref 2016 \fi 2017 2018 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the 2019 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and 2020 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have 2021 % this property, we can check that font parameter. 2022 % 2023 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt } 2024 2025 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the 2026 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt. 2027 % 2028 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1} 2029 2030 \def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par} 2031 2032 % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'', 2033 % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for 2034 % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96. 2035 %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null} 2036 2037 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii. 2038 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font 2039 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font 2040 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font 2041 2042 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like. 2043 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for 2044 % all-uppercase. 2045 % 2046 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish} 2047 \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{% 2048 {\selectfonts\lsize #1}% 2049 \def\temp{#2}% 2050 \ifx\temp\empty \else 2051 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})% 2052 \fi 2053 } 2054 2055 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like. 2056 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing. 2057 % 2058 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish} 2059 \def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{% 2060 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}% 2061 \def\temp{#2}% 2062 \ifx\temp\empty \else 2063 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})% 2064 \fi 2065 } 2066 2067 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font. 2068 % 2069 \def\pounds{{\it\$}} 2070 2071 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style. 2072 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik 2073 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and 2074 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need). 2075 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym. 2076 % 2077 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore 2078 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular 2079 % font height. 2080 % 2081 % feymr - regular 2082 % feymo - slanted 2083 % feybr - bold 2084 % feybo - bold slanted 2085 % 2086 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge. 2087 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide. 2088 % Hmm. 2089 % 2090 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols? 2091 % Hope not. 2092 % 2093 % 2094 \def\euro{{\eurofont e}} 2095 \def\eurofont{% 2096 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in 2097 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that 2098 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the 2099 % font installed. 2100 % 2101 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale 2102 % that to the current nominal size. 2103 % 2104 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but 2105 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts. 2106 % 2107 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}% 2108 % 2109 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename 2110 % bold: 2111 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize 2112 \else 2113 % regular: 2114 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize 2115 \fi 2116 \thiseurofont 2117 } 2118 2119 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really 2120 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now. 2121 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright. 2122 % 2123 \def\registeredsymbol{% 2124 $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}% 2125 \hfil\crcr\Orb}}% 2126 }$% 2127 } 2128 2129 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with: 2130 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38 2131 % so we'll define it if necessary. 2132 % 2133 \ifx\Orb\undefined 2134 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D} 2135 \fi 2136 2137 2138 \message{page headings,} 2139 2140 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in 2141 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc 2142 2143 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage. 2144 \newif\ifseenauthor 2145 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage 2146 2147 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the 2148 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage. 2149 % 2150 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage 2151 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue 2152 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage 2153 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue 2154 2155 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}% 2156 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page} 2157 2158 \envdef\titlepage{% 2159 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage. 2160 \begingroup 2161 \parindent=0pt \textfonts 2162 % Leave some space at the very top of the page. 2163 \vglue\titlepagetopglue 2164 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title. 2165 \finishedtitlepagetrue 2166 % 2167 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space 2168 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second. 2169 \let\oldpage = \page 2170 \def\page{% 2171 \iffinishedtitlepage\else 2172 \finishtitlepage 2173 \fi 2174 \let\page = \oldpage 2175 \page 2176 \null 2177 }% 2178 } 2179 2180 \def\Etitlepage{% 2181 \iffinishedtitlepage\else 2182 \finishtitlepage 2183 \fi 2184 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group, 2185 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group. 2186 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page 2187 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want. 2188 \oldpage 2189 \endgroup 2190 % 2191 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are 2192 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers. 2193 \HEADINGSon 2194 % 2195 % If they want short, they certainly want long too. 2196 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage 2197 \shortcontents 2198 \contents 2199 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax 2200 \global\let\contents = \relax 2201 \fi 2202 % 2203 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage 2204 \contents 2205 \global\let\contents = \relax 2206 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax 2207 \fi 2208 } 2209 2210 \def\finishtitlepage{% 2211 \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize 2212 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue 2213 \finishedtitlepagetrue 2214 } 2215 2216 %%% Macros to be used within @titlepage: 2217 2218 \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm 2219 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines} 2220 2221 \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines 2222 \let\tt=\authortt} 2223 2224 \parseargdef\title{% 2225 \checkenv\titlepage 2226 \leftline{\titlefonts\rm #1} 2227 % print a rule at the page bottom also. 2228 \finishedtitlepagefalse 2229 \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt 2230 } 2231 2232 \parseargdef\subtitle{% 2233 \checkenv\titlepage 2234 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}% 2235 } 2236 2237 % @author should come last, but may come many times. 2238 % It can also be used inside @quotation. 2239 % 2240 \parseargdef\author{% 2241 \def\temp{\quotation}% 2242 \ifx\thisenv\temp 2243 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation. 2244 \else 2245 \checkenv\titlepage 2246 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi 2247 {\authorfont \leftline{#1}}% 2248 \fi 2249 } 2250 2251 2252 %%% Set up page headings and footings. 2253 2254 \let\thispage=\folio 2255 2256 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages 2257 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages 2258 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages 2259 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages 2260 2261 % Now make TeX use those variables 2262 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline 2263 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}} 2264 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline 2265 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook} 2266 \let\HEADINGShook=\relax 2267 2268 % Commands to set those variables. 2269 % For example, this is what @headings on does 2270 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter 2271 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle 2272 % @evenfooting @thisfile|| 2273 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile 2274 2275 2276 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx} 2277 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} 2278 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% 2279 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} 2280 2281 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx} 2282 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} 2283 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% 2284 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} 2285 2286 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}% 2287 2288 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx} 2289 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} 2290 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% 2291 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} 2292 2293 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx} 2294 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} 2295 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% 2296 \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}% 2297 % 2298 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume 2299 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself. 2300 \global\advance\pageheight by -\baselineskip 2301 \global\advance\vsize by -\baselineskip 2302 } 2303 2304 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}} 2305 2306 2307 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing. 2308 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing. 2309 % @headings off turns them off. 2310 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility. 2311 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page. 2312 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page. 2313 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page. 2314 % By default, they are off at the start of a document, 2315 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage. 2316 2317 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname} 2318 2319 \def\HEADINGSoff{% 2320 \global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil} 2321 \global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}} 2322 \HEADINGSoff 2323 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1. 2324 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner, 2325 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document 2326 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top 2327 % edge of all pages. 2328 \def\HEADINGSdouble{% 2329 \global\pageno=1 2330 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} 2331 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} 2332 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} 2333 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} 2334 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage 2335 } 2336 \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager 2337 2338 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page, 2339 % page number on top right. 2340 \def\HEADINGSsingle{% 2341 \global\pageno=1 2342 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} 2343 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} 2344 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} 2345 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} 2346 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager 2347 } 2348 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble} 2349 2350 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex} 2351 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter 2352 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{% 2353 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} 2354 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} 2355 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} 2356 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} 2357 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage 2358 } 2359 2360 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex} 2361 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{% 2362 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} 2363 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} 2364 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} 2365 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} 2366 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager 2367 } 2368 2369 % Subroutines used in generating headings 2370 % This produces Day Month Year style of output. 2371 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set 2372 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this). 2373 \ifx\today\undefined 2374 \def\today{% 2375 \number\day\space 2376 \ifcase\month 2377 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr 2378 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug 2379 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec 2380 \fi 2381 \space\number\year} 2382 \fi 2383 2384 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings. 2385 % It generates no output of its own. 2386 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle} 2387 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}} 2388 2389 2390 \message{tables,} 2391 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x). 2392 2393 % default indentation of table text 2394 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in 2395 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text 2396 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in 2397 % margin between end of table item and start of table text. 2398 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in 2399 2400 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin 2401 \newdimen\itemmax 2402 2403 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with 2404 % these defs. 2405 % They also define \itemindex 2406 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none). 2407 2408 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip 2409 2410 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi} 2411 2412 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz} 2413 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz} 2414 2415 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup % 2416 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip 2417 \advance\hsize by -\tableindent 2418 \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}% 2419 \itemindex{#1}% 2420 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx. 2421 % 2422 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line 2423 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that 2424 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next 2425 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the 2426 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space. 2427 \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax 2428 % 2429 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping, 2430 % but leave it ragged-right. 2431 \begingroup 2432 \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent 2433 \advance\hsize by\tableindent 2434 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil 2435 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par 2436 \endgroup 2437 % 2438 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the 2439 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started. 2440 \nobreak \vskip-\parskip 2441 % 2442 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if 2443 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no 2444 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would 2445 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this 2446 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert 2447 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also. 2448 % 2449 \penalty 10001 2450 \endgroup 2451 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse 2452 \else 2453 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the 2454 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line. 2455 \noindent 2456 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in 2457 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and 2458 % eventually be printed. 2459 \nobreak\kern-\tableindent 2460 \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 2461 \unhbox0 2462 \nobreak\kern\dimen0 2463 \endgroup 2464 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue 2465 \fi 2466 } 2467 2468 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}} 2469 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}} 2470 2471 % @table, @ftable, @vtable. 2472 \envdef\table{% 2473 \let\itemindex\gobble 2474 \tablecheck{table}% 2475 } 2476 \envdef\ftable{% 2477 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}% 2478 \tablecheck{ftable}% 2479 } 2480 \envdef\vtable{% 2481 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}% 2482 \tablecheck{vtable}% 2483 } 2484 \def\tablecheck#1{% 2485 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active 2486 \endgroup 2487 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is 2488 that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}% 2489 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}% 2490 \else 2491 \let\next\tablex 2492 \fi 2493 \next 2494 } 2495 \def\tablex#1{% 2496 \def\itemindicate{#1}% 2497 \parsearg\tabley 2498 } 2499 \def\tabley#1{% 2500 {% 2501 \makevalueexpandable 2502 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}% 2503 \expandafter 2504 }\temp \endtablez 2505 } 2506 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{% 2507 \aboveenvbreak 2508 \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi 2509 \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi 2510 \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi 2511 \itemmax=\tableindent 2512 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin 2513 \advance \leftskip by \tableindent 2514 \exdentamount=\tableindent 2515 \parindent = 0pt 2516 \parskip = \smallskipamount 2517 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi 2518 \let\item = \internalBitem 2519 \let\itemx = \internalBitemx 2520 } 2521 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak} 2522 \let\Eftable\Etable 2523 \let\Evtable\Etable 2524 \let\Eitemize\Etable 2525 \let\Eenumerate\Etable 2526 2527 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize 2528 2529 \newcount \itemno 2530 2531 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize} 2532 2533 \def\doitemize#1{% 2534 \aboveenvbreak 2535 \itemmax=\itemindent 2536 \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin 2537 \advance\leftskip by \itemindent 2538 \exdentamount=\itemindent 2539 \parindent=0pt 2540 \parskip=\smallskipamount 2541 \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi 2542 \def\itemcontents{#1}% 2543 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet. 2544 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi 2545 \let\item=\itemizeitem 2546 } 2547 2548 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate. 2549 % 2550 \def\itemizeitem{% 2551 \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations 2552 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break 2553 {% 2554 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a 2555 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have 2556 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero 2557 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the 2558 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there 2559 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much 2560 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least 2561 % that's the theory. 2562 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi 2563 \noindent 2564 \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}% 2565 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item. 2566 \flushcr 2567 } 2568 2569 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in 2570 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder. 2571 % 2572 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}% 2573 2574 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter, 2575 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No 2576 % argument is the same as `1'. 2577 % 2578 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey} 2579 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{% 2580 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'. 2581 \def\thearg{#1}% 2582 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi 2583 % 2584 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a 2585 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number. 2586 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made. 2587 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at 2588 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.) 2589 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark 2590 \ifx\rest\empty 2591 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything. 2592 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero. 2593 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and 2594 % not equal to itself. 2595 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number. 2596 % 2597 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from 2598 % continuing to look for a <number>. 2599 % 2600 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax 2601 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope) 2602 \else 2603 % It's a letter. 2604 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax 2605 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter 2606 \else 2607 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter 2608 \fi 2609 \fi 2610 \else 2611 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number. 2612 \numericenumerate 2613 \fi 2614 } 2615 2616 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is 2617 % given in \thearg. 2618 % 2619 \def\numericenumerate{% 2620 \itemno = \thearg 2621 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}% 2622 } 2623 2624 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg. 2625 \def\lowercaseenumerate{% 2626 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg 2627 \startenumeration{% 2628 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. 2629 \ifnum\itemno=0 2630 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger 2631 alphabet}% 2632 \fi 2633 \char\lccode\itemno 2634 }% 2635 } 2636 2637 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg. 2638 \def\uppercaseenumerate{% 2639 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg 2640 \startenumeration{% 2641 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. 2642 \ifnum\itemno=0 2643 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger 2644 alphabet} 2645 \fi 2646 \char\uccode\itemno 2647 }% 2648 } 2649 2650 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the 2651 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in 2652 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno. 2653 % 2654 \def\startenumeration#1{% 2655 \advance\itemno by -1 2656 \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr 2657 } 2658 2659 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg 2660 % to @enumerate. 2661 % 2662 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}} 2663 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}} 2664 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate} 2665 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate} 2666 2667 2668 % @multitable macros 2669 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96 2670 % 2671 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired. 2672 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width 2673 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line, 2674 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page. 2675 2676 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines. 2677 2678 % To make preamble: 2679 % 2680 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize: 2681 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45 2682 % @item ... 2683 % 2684 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total 2685 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many 2686 % columns as desired. 2687 2688 2689 % Or use a template: 2690 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} 2691 % @item ... 2692 % using the widest term desired in each column. 2693 2694 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column 2695 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's 2696 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed, 2697 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns. 2698 2699 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt 2700 % if they are. 2701 2702 % Sample multitable: 2703 2704 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} 2705 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col 2706 % @item 2707 % first col stuff 2708 % @tab 2709 % second col stuff 2710 % @tab 2711 % third col 2712 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff 2713 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column. 2714 % 2715 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template. 2716 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column. 2717 % @end multitable 2718 2719 % Default dimensions may be reset by user. 2720 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table. 2721 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table. 2722 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns. 2723 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline 2724 % to baseline. 2725 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing. 2726 % 2727 \newskip\multitableparskip 2728 \newskip\multitableparindent 2729 \newdimen\multitablecolspace 2730 \newskip\multitablelinespace 2731 \multitableparskip=0pt 2732 \multitableparindent=6pt 2733 \multitablecolspace=12pt 2734 \multitablelinespace=0pt 2735 2736 % Macros used to set up halign preamble: 2737 % 2738 \let\endsetuptable\relax 2739 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable} 2740 \let\columnfractions\relax 2741 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions} 2742 \newif\ifsetpercent 2743 2744 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might 2745 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is. 2746 % 2747 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {% 2748 \global\advance\colcount by 1 2749 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}% 2750 \setuptable 2751 } 2752 2753 \newcount\colcount 2754 \def\setuptable#1{% 2755 \def\firstarg{#1}% 2756 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable 2757 \let\go = \relax 2758 \else 2759 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions 2760 \global\setpercenttrue 2761 \else 2762 \ifsetpercent 2763 \let\go\pickupwholefraction 2764 \else 2765 \global\advance\colcount by 1 2766 \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a 2767 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway. 2768 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}% 2769 \fi 2770 \fi 2771 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction 2772 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so 2773 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed. 2774 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}% 2775 \else 2776 \let\go = \setuptable 2777 \fi% 2778 \fi 2779 \go 2780 } 2781 2782 % multitable-only commands. 2783 % 2784 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold. 2785 % Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group 2786 % of an alignment entry. Note that \everycr resets \everytab. 2787 \def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab={\bf}\the\everytab}% 2788 % 2789 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template 2790 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until 2791 % we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again. 2792 % --karl, nathan (a] acm.org, 20apr99. 2793 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}% 2794 2795 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions: 2796 % 2797 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab. 2798 % 2799 \envdef\multitable{% 2800 \vskip\parskip 2801 \startsavinginserts 2802 % 2803 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row. 2804 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries 2805 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka 2806 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize. 2807 \def\item{\crcr}% 2808 % 2809 \tolerance=9500 2810 \hbadness=9500 2811 \setmultitablespacing 2812 \parskip=\multitableparskip 2813 \parindent=\multitableparindent 2814 \overfullrule=0pt 2815 \global\colcount=0 2816 % 2817 \everycr = {% 2818 \noalign{% 2819 \global\everytab={}% 2820 \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter. 2821 % Check for saved footnotes, etc. 2822 \checkinserts 2823 % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages. 2824 %\filbreak 2825 % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the 2826 % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the 2827 % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl. 2828 }% 2829 }% 2830 % 2831 \parsearg\domultitable 2832 } 2833 \def\domultitable#1{% 2834 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item: 2835 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable 2836 % 2837 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will 2838 % be used as many times as user calls for columns. 2839 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and 2840 % continue for many paragraphs if desired. 2841 \halign\bgroup &% 2842 \global\advance\colcount by 1 2843 \multistrut 2844 \vtop{% 2845 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width: 2846 \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname 2847 % 2848 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other 2849 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after 2850 % the first one. 2851 % 2852 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace 2853 % to the width of each template entry. 2854 % 2855 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will 2856 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip 2857 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at 2858 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin. 2859 % 2860 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment. 2861 \rightskip=0pt 2862 \ifnum\colcount=1 2863 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text. 2864 \advance\hsize by\leftskip 2865 \else 2866 \ifsetpercent \else 2867 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize 2868 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace. 2869 \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace 2870 \fi 2871 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace: 2872 \leftskip=\multitablecolspace 2873 \fi 2874 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious 2875 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the 2876 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself. 2877 % For example: 2878 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89 2879 % @item @code{#} 2880 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country. 2881 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively 2882 % marking characters. 2883 \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut 2884 }\cr 2885 } 2886 \def\Emultitable{% 2887 \crcr 2888 \egroup % end the \halign 2889 \global\setpercentfalse 2890 } 2891 2892 \def\setmultitablespacing{% 2893 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing 2894 % 2895 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in 2896 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on 2897 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off. 2898 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100. 2899 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt 2900 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip 2901 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0 2902 \fi 2903 %% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of 2904 %% table. If not, do nothing. 2905 %% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace. 2906 \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace 2907 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace 2908 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller 2909 %% than skip between lines in the table. 2910 \fi% 2911 \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt 2912 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace 2913 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller 2914 %% than skip between lines in the table. 2915 \fi} 2916 2917 2918 \message{conditionals,} 2919 2920 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext, 2921 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't 2922 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we 2923 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't 2924 % attempt to close an environment group. 2925 % 2926 \def\makecond#1{% 2927 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax 2928 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1 2929 } 2930 \makecond{iftex} 2931 \makecond{ifnotdocbook} 2932 \makecond{ifnothtml} 2933 \makecond{ifnotinfo} 2934 \makecond{ifnotplaintext} 2935 \makecond{ifnotxml} 2936 2937 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like. 2938 % 2939 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}} 2940 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}} 2941 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}} 2942 \def\html{\doignore{html}} 2943 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}} 2944 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}} 2945 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}} 2946 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}} 2947 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}} 2948 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}} 2949 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}} 2950 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}} 2951 \def\xml{\doignore{xml}} 2952 2953 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals. 2954 % 2955 % A count to remember the depth of nesting. 2956 \newcount\doignorecount 2957 2958 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup 2959 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode: 2960 \obeylines 2961 \catcode`\@ = \other 2962 \catcode`\{ = \other 2963 \catcode`\} = \other 2964 % 2965 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants. 2966 \spaceisspace 2967 % 2968 % Count number of #1's that we've seen. 2969 \doignorecount = 0 2970 % 2971 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'. 2972 \dodoignore{#1}% 2973 } 2974 2975 { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source. 2976 \obeylines % 2977 % 2978 \gdef\dodoignore#1{% 2979 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'. 2980 % 2981 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'. 2982 \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{% 2983 \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}% 2984 % 2985 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a 2986 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for 2987 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.) 2988 \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}% 2989 % 2990 % And now expand that command. 2991 \doignoretext ^^M% 2992 }% 2993 } 2994 2995 \def\doignoreyyy#1{% 2996 \def\temp{#1}% 2997 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found. 2998 \let\next\doignoretextzzz 2999 \else % Found a nested condition, ... 3000 \advance\doignorecount by 1 3001 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another. 3002 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example). 3003 \fi 3004 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro. 3005 } 3006 3007 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_". 3008 % 3009 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{% 3010 \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end. 3011 \let\next\enddoignore 3012 \else % Still inside a nested condition. 3013 \advance\doignorecount by -1 3014 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end. 3015 \fi 3016 \next 3017 } 3018 3019 % Finish off ignored text. 3020 { \obeylines% 3021 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim 3022 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional 3023 % would result in a blank line in the output. 3024 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}% 3025 } 3026 3027 3028 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value. 3029 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE. 3030 % 3031 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be 3032 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our 3033 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we 3034 % didn't need it. 3035 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10. 3036 % 3037 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy} 3038 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{% 3039 {% 3040 \makevalueexpandable 3041 \def\temp{#2}% 3042 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}% 3043 \ifx\temp\empty 3044 \next{}% 3045 \else 3046 \setzzz#2\endsetzzz 3047 \fi 3048 }% 3049 } 3050 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted. 3051 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}} 3052 3053 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR. 3054 % 3055 \parseargdef\clear{% 3056 {% 3057 \makevalueexpandable 3058 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax 3059 }% 3060 } 3061 3062 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo. 3063 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx} 3064 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup} 3065 { 3066 \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active 3067 % 3068 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{% 3069 \let\value = \expandablevalue 3070 % We don't want these characters active, ... 3071 \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other 3072 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if 3073 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though. 3074 % So \let them to their normal equivalents. 3075 \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore 3076 } 3077 } 3078 3079 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's 3080 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies). 3081 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since 3082 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the 3083 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain 3084 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work 3085 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete). 3086 % 3087 \def\expandablevalue#1{% 3088 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax 3089 {[No value for ``#1'']}% 3090 \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}% 3091 \else 3092 \csname SET#1\endcsname 3093 \fi 3094 } 3095 3096 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined 3097 % with @set. 3098 % 3099 % To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine. 3100 % 3101 \makecond{ifset} 3102 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}} 3103 \def\doifset#1#2{% 3104 {% 3105 \makevalueexpandable 3106 \let\next=\empty 3107 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax 3108 #1% If not set, redefine \next. 3109 \fi 3110 \expandafter 3111 }\next 3112 } 3113 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}} 3114 3115 % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been 3116 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear. 3117 % 3118 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the 3119 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set, 3120 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail. 3121 % 3122 \makecond{ifclear} 3123 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}} 3124 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}} 3125 3126 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file 3127 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX. 3128 \let\dircategory=\comment 3129 3130 % @defininfoenclose. 3131 \let\definfoenclose=\comment 3132 3133 3134 \message{indexing,} 3135 % Index generation facilities 3136 3137 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite 3138 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's. 3139 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}} 3140 3141 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo. 3142 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that 3143 % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo. 3144 % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for 3145 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo. 3146 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long 3147 % for the sake of vms. 3148 % 3149 \def\newindex#1{% 3150 \iflinks 3151 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname 3152 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file 3153 \fi 3154 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index 3155 \noexpand\doindex{#1}} 3156 } 3157 3158 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo} 3159 % 3160 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex} 3161 3162 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code. 3163 % 3164 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex} 3165 % 3166 \def\newcodeindex#1{% 3167 \iflinks 3168 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname 3169 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 3170 \fi 3171 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% 3172 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}% 3173 } 3174 3175 3176 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar. 3177 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index. 3178 % 3179 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo 3180 % inside @code. 3181 % 3182 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}} 3183 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}} 3184 3185 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo), 3186 % #3 the target index (bar). 3187 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{% 3188 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up 3189 % closing the target index. 3190 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \undefined 3191 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the 3192 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files. 3193 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname 3194 \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1 3195 \fi 3196 % redefine \fooindfile: 3197 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname 3198 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp 3199 % redefine \fooindex: 3200 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}% 3201 } 3202 3203 % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros. 3204 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro, 3205 % and it is "foo", the name of the index. 3206 3207 % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work. 3208 % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros. 3209 3210 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic} 3211 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index. 3212 3213 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer} 3214 \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}} 3215 3216 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument. 3217 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer} 3218 \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}} 3219 3220 % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry. 3221 % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't, 3222 % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't. 3223 % 3224 \def\indexdummies{% 3225 \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files. 3226 \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files. 3227 \def\ {\realbackslash\space }% 3228 % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again. 3229 % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes 3230 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. 3231 \let\{ = \mylbrace 3232 \let\} = \myrbrace 3233 % 3234 % Do the redefinitions. 3235 \commondummies 3236 } 3237 3238 % For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to 3239 % redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of 3240 % \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @, 3241 % this will be simpler. 3242 % 3243 \def\atdummies{% 3244 \def\@{@@}% 3245 \def\ {@ }% 3246 \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd 3247 \let\} = \rbraceatcmd 3248 % 3249 % Do the redefinitions. 3250 \commondummies 3251 \otherbackslash 3252 } 3253 3254 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies. 3255 % 3256 \def\commondummies{% 3257 % 3258 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively 3259 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control% words, 3260 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for 3261 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word 3262 % from whatever follows. 3263 % 3264 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the 3265 % space. 3266 % 3267 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and 3268 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then 3269 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever). 3270 % 3271 \def\definedummyword ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}% 3272 \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}% 3273 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter 3274 % 3275 \commondummiesnofonts 3276 % 3277 \definedummyletter\_% 3278 % 3279 % Non-English letters. 3280 \definedummyword\AA 3281 \definedummyword\AE 3282 \definedummyword\L 3283 \definedummyword\OE 3284 \definedummyword\O 3285 \definedummyword\aa 3286 \definedummyword\ae 3287 \definedummyword\l 3288 \definedummyword\oe 3289 \definedummyword\o 3290 \definedummyword\ss 3291 \definedummyword\exclamdown 3292 \definedummyword\questiondown 3293 \definedummyword\ordf 3294 \definedummyword\ordm 3295 % 3296 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do. 3297 \definedummyword\bf 3298 \definedummyword\gtr 3299 \definedummyword\hat 3300 \definedummyword\less 3301 \definedummyword\sf 3302 \definedummyword\sl 3303 \definedummyword\tclose 3304 \definedummyword\tt 3305 % 3306 \definedummyword\LaTeX 3307 \definedummyword\TeX 3308 % 3309 % Assorted special characters. 3310 \definedummyword\bullet 3311 \definedummyword\comma 3312 \definedummyword\copyright 3313 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol 3314 \definedummyword\dots 3315 \definedummyword\enddots 3316 \definedummyword\equiv 3317 \definedummyword\error 3318 \definedummyword\euro 3319 \definedummyword\expansion 3320 \definedummyword\minus 3321 \definedummyword\pounds 3322 \definedummyword\point 3323 \definedummyword\print 3324 \definedummyword\result 3325 % 3326 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write. 3327 \macrolist 3328 % 3329 \normalturnoffactive 3330 % 3331 % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any 3332 % (non-fully-expandable) commands. 3333 \makevalueexpandable 3334 } 3335 3336 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts. 3337 % 3338 \def\commondummiesnofonts{% 3339 % Control letters and accents. 3340 \definedummyletter\!% 3341 \definedummyaccent\"% 3342 \definedummyaccent\'% 3343 \definedummyletter\*% 3344 \definedummyaccent\,% 3345 \definedummyletter\.% 3346 \definedummyletter\/% 3347 \definedummyletter\:% 3348 \definedummyaccent\=% 3349 \definedummyletter\?% 3350 \definedummyaccent\^% 3351 \definedummyaccent\`% 3352 \definedummyaccent\~% 3353 \definedummyword\u 3354 \definedummyword\v 3355 \definedummyword\H 3356 \definedummyword\dotaccent 3357 \definedummyword\ringaccent 3358 \definedummyword\tieaccent 3359 \definedummyword\ubaraccent 3360 \definedummyword\udotaccent 3361 \definedummyword\dotless 3362 % 3363 % Texinfo font commands. 3364 \definedummyword\b 3365 \definedummyword\i 3366 \definedummyword\r 3367 \definedummyword\sc 3368 \definedummyword\t 3369 % 3370 % Commands that take arguments. 3371 \definedummyword\acronym 3372 \definedummyword\cite 3373 \definedummyword\code 3374 \definedummyword\command 3375 \definedummyword\dfn 3376 \definedummyword\emph 3377 \definedummyword\env 3378 \definedummyword\file 3379 \definedummyword\kbd 3380 \definedummyword\key 3381 \definedummyword\math 3382 \definedummyword\option 3383 \definedummyword\pxref 3384 \definedummyword\ref 3385 \definedummyword\samp 3386 \definedummyword\strong 3387 \definedummyword\tie 3388 \definedummyword\uref 3389 \definedummyword\url 3390 \definedummyword\var 3391 \definedummyword\verb 3392 \definedummyword\w 3393 \definedummyword\xref 3394 } 3395 3396 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index 3397 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all 3398 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string 3399 % would be for a given command (usually its argument). 3400 % 3401 \def\indexnofonts{% 3402 % Accent commands should become @asis. 3403 \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}% 3404 % We can just ignore other control letters. 3405 \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}% 3406 % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis. 3407 \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent 3408 % 3409 \commondummiesnofonts 3410 % 3411 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command 3412 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc. 3413 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands. 3414 %\let\tt=\asis 3415 % 3416 \def\ { }% 3417 \def\@{@}% 3418 % how to handle braces? 3419 \def\_{\normalunderscore}% 3420 % 3421 % Non-English letters. 3422 \def\AA{AA}% 3423 \def\AE{AE}% 3424 \def\L{L}% 3425 \def\OE{OE}% 3426 \def\O{O}% 3427 \def\aa{aa}% 3428 \def\ae{ae}% 3429 \def\l{l}% 3430 \def\oe{oe}% 3431 \def\o{o}% 3432 \def\ss{ss}% 3433 \def\exclamdown{!}% 3434 \def\questiondown{?}% 3435 \def\ordf{a}% 3436 \def\ordm{o}% 3437 % 3438 \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}% 3439 \def\TeX{TeX}% 3440 % 3441 % Assorted special characters. 3442 % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.) 3443 \def\bullet{bullet}% 3444 \def\comma{,}% 3445 \def\copyright{copyright}% 3446 \def\registeredsymbol{R}% 3447 \def\dots{...}% 3448 \def\enddots{...}% 3449 \def\equiv{==}% 3450 \def\error{error}% 3451 \def\euro{euro}% 3452 \def\expansion{==>}% 3453 \def\minus{-}% 3454 \def\pounds{pounds}% 3455 \def\point{.}% 3456 \def\print{-|}% 3457 \def\result{=>}% 3458 % 3459 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present). 3460 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now. 3461 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up 3462 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry 3463 % that starts with \. 3464 % 3465 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them 3466 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that 3467 % goes to end-of-line is not handled. 3468 % 3469 \macrolist 3470 } 3471 3472 \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex. 3473 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)? 3474 3475 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case. 3476 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text. 3477 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}} 3478 3479 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes. 3480 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry -- 3481 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception 3482 % is with most defuns, which call us directly). 3483 % 3484 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{% 3485 \iflinks 3486 {% 3487 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg). 3488 \toks0 = {#2}% 3489 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space. 3490 \def\thirdarg{#3}% 3491 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else 3492 \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}% 3493 \fi 3494 % 3495 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}% 3496 % 3497 \ifvmode 3498 \dosubindsanitize 3499 \else 3500 \dosubindwrite 3501 \fi 3502 }% 3503 \fi 3504 } 3505 3506 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file: 3507 % 3508 \def\dosubindwrite{% 3509 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired. 3510 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else 3511 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}% 3512 \fi 3513 % 3514 % Remember, we are within a group. 3515 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage 3516 \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now 3517 % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash. 3518 % 3519 % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to 3520 % get the string to sort by. 3521 {\indexnofonts 3522 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion 3523 \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}% 3524 }% 3525 % 3526 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and 3527 % the original text, including any font commands. We write 3528 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the 3529 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s 3530 % sorted result. 3531 \edef\temp{% 3532 \write\writeto{% 3533 \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}% 3534 }% 3535 \temp 3536 } 3537 3538 % Take care of unwanted page breaks: 3539 % 3540 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it 3541 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting 3542 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the 3543 % \write will make \lastskip zero. The result is that sequences 3544 % like this: 3545 % @end defun 3546 % @tindex whatever 3547 % @defun ... 3548 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the 3549 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of 3550 % the previous defun. 3551 % 3552 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We 3553 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph. 3554 % 3555 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too. 3556 % 3557 % But wait, there is a catch there: 3558 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not 3559 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts 3560 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual 3561 % representation of the skip. 3562 % 3563 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that 3564 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter). 3565 % 3566 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname} 3567 % 3568 % ..., ready, GO: 3569 % 3570 \def\dosubindsanitize{% 3571 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously. 3572 \skip0 = \lastskip 3573 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}% 3574 \count255 = \lastpenalty 3575 % 3576 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a 3577 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this 3578 % -\skip0 glue we're inserting is preceded by a 3579 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential 3580 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed. 3581 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro 3582 \else 3583 \vskip-\skip0 3584 \fi 3585 % 3586 \dosubindwrite 3587 % 3588 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro 3589 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and 3590 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want 3591 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various 3592 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any 3593 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example: 3594 % 3595 % @deffn deffn-whatever 3596 % @vindex index-whatever 3597 % Description. 3598 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit 3599 % and the "Description." paragraph. 3600 \ifnum\count255>9999 \penalty\count255 \fi 3601 \else 3602 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip, 3603 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item 3604 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak. 3605 \nobreak\vskip\skip0 3606 \fi 3607 } 3608 3609 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like 3610 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic} 3611 % or 3612 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic} 3613 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files 3614 % containing these kinds of lines: 3615 % \initial {c} 3616 % before the first topic whose initial is c 3617 % \entry {topic}{pagelist} 3618 % for a topic that is used without subtopics 3619 % \primary {topic} 3620 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics 3621 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist} 3622 % for each subtopic. 3623 3624 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands 3625 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex. 3626 3627 \def\findex {\fnindex} 3628 \def\kindex {\kyindex} 3629 \def\cindex {\cpindex} 3630 \def\vindex {\vrindex} 3631 \def\tindex {\tpindex} 3632 \def\pindex {\pgindex} 3633 3634 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub} 3635 {\obeylines % 3636 \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup % 3637 \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}} 3638 3639 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material. 3640 3641 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed. 3642 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered). 3643 % 3644 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup 3645 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}% 3646 % 3647 \smallfonts \rm 3648 \tolerance = 9500 3649 \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression. 3650 % 3651 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty. 3652 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains 3653 % \initial {@} 3654 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces 3655 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence). 3656 \catcode`\@ = 11 3657 \openin 1 \jobname.#1s 3658 \ifeof 1 3659 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index, 3660 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the 3661 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure 3662 % there is some text. 3663 \putwordIndexNonexistent 3664 \else 3665 % 3666 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof 3667 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so 3668 % it can discover if there is anything in it. 3669 \read 1 to \temp 3670 \ifeof 1 3671 \putwordIndexIsEmpty 3672 \else 3673 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape 3674 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change 3675 % to make right now. 3676 \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}% 3677 \catcode`\\ = 0 3678 \escapechar = `\\ 3679 \begindoublecolumns 3680 \input \jobname.#1s 3681 \enddoublecolumns 3682 \fi 3683 \fi 3684 \closein 1 3685 \endgroup} 3686 3687 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself. 3688 % Change them to control the appearance of the index. 3689 3690 \def\initial#1{{% 3691 % Some minor font changes for the special characters. 3692 \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt 3693 % 3694 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own. 3695 \removelastskip 3696 % 3697 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus. 3698 \nobreak 3699 \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip 3700 \penalty 0 3701 \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip 3702 % 3703 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of 3704 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column 3705 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch 3706 % we need before each entry, but it's better. 3707 % 3708 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns. 3709 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip 3710 \leftline{\secbf #1}% 3711 % Do our best not to break after the initial. 3712 \nobreak 3713 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip 3714 }} 3715 3716 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and 3717 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index 3718 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip. 3719 % 3720 % A straightforward implementation would start like this: 3721 % \def\entry#1#2{... 3722 % But this frozes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to 3723 % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge--- 3724 % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right. 3725 % 3726 % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text. 3727 % --kasal, 21nov03 3728 \def\entry{% 3729 \begingroup 3730 % 3731 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't 3732 % affect previous text. 3733 \par 3734 % 3735 % Do not fill out the last line with white space. 3736 \parfillskip = 0in 3737 % 3738 % No extra space above this paragraph. 3739 \parskip = 0in 3740 % 3741 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines. 3742 \finalhyphendemerits = 0 3743 % 3744 % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number 3745 % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the 3746 % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large 3747 % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across 3748 % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders. 3749 % 3750 % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start 3751 % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that. 3752 \hangindent = 2em 3753 % 3754 % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line 3755 % with blank space. 3756 \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil 3757 % 3758 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing 3759 % columns. 3760 \vskip 0pt plus1pt 3761 % 3762 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter): 3763 \afterassignment\doentry 3764 \let\temp = 3765 } 3766 \def\doentry{% 3767 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace. 3768 \noindent 3769 \aftergroup\finishentry 3770 % And now comes the text of the entry. 3771 } 3772 \def\finishentry#1{% 3773 % #1 is the page number. 3774 % 3775 % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if 3776 % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be 3777 % cursed by a Unix daemon. 3778 \def\tempa{{\rm }}% 3779 \def\tempb{#1}% 3780 \edef\tempc{\tempa}% 3781 \edef\tempd{\tempb}% 3782 \ifx\tempc\tempd 3783 \ % 3784 \else 3785 % 3786 % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out 3787 % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the 3788 % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.) 3789 \hfil\penalty50 3790 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number. 3791 % 3792 % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as 3793 % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull 3794 % \hbox ensues. 3795 \ifpdf 3796 \pdfgettoks#1.% 3797 \ \the\toksA 3798 \else 3799 \ #1% 3800 \fi 3801 \fi 3802 \par 3803 \endgroup 3804 } 3805 3806 % Like \dotfill except takes at least 1 em. 3807 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders 3808 \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu ${\it .}$ \mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill} 3809 3810 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}} 3811 3812 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm 3813 \def\secondary#1#2{{% 3814 \parfillskip=0in 3815 \parskip=0in 3816 \hangindent=1in 3817 \hangafter=1 3818 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill 3819 \ifpdf 3820 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph. 3821 \else 3822 #2 3823 \fi 3824 \par 3825 }} 3826 3827 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes. 3828 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say, 3829 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself. 3830 \catcode`\@=11 3831 3832 \newbox\partialpage 3833 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize 3834 3835 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns 3836 % Grab any single-column material above us. 3837 \output = {% 3838 % 3839 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a 3840 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output 3841 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is 3842 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In 3843 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal 3844 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this 3845 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case. 3846 \ifvoid\partialpage \else 3847 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}% 3848 \fi 3849 % 3850 \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{% 3851 % Unvbox the main output page. 3852 \unvbox\PAGE 3853 \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip 3854 }% 3855 }% 3856 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage 3857 % 3858 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages. 3859 \output = {\doublecolumnout}% 3860 % 3861 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this 3862 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11 3863 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple 3864 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the 3865 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place. 3866 % 3867 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between 3868 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it 3869 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant 3870 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt) 3871 % as it did when we hard-coded it. 3872 % 3873 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we 3874 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially) 3875 % been clobbered. 3876 % 3877 \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize 3878 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize 3879 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2 3880 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize 3881 % 3882 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here, 3883 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.) 3884 \vsize = 2\vsize 3885 } 3886 3887 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except 3888 % the last. 3889 % 3890 \def\doublecolumnout{% 3891 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth 3892 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal 3893 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the 3894 % previous page. 3895 \dimen@ = \vsize 3896 \divide\dimen@ by 2 3897 \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage 3898 % 3899 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right. 3900 \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ 3901 \onepageout\pagesofar 3902 \unvbox255 3903 \penalty\outputpenalty 3904 } 3905 % 3906 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material, 3907 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2. 3908 \def\pagesofar{% 3909 \unvbox\partialpage 3910 % 3911 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize 3912 \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize 3913 \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}% 3914 } 3915 % 3916 % All done with double columns. 3917 \def\enddoublecolumns{% 3918 \output = {% 3919 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the 3920 % current page, no automatic page break. 3921 \balancecolumns 3922 % 3923 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page, 3924 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output 3925 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not 3926 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal 3927 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be 3928 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes 3929 % the output somewhat more palatable.) 3930 \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}% 3931 }% 3932 \eject 3933 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns 3934 % 3935 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted 3936 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column 3937 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the 3938 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored). 3939 \pagegoal = \vsize 3940 } 3941 % 3942 % Called at the end of the double column material. 3943 \def\balancecolumns{% 3944 \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120. 3945 \dimen@ = \ht0 3946 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip 3947 \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip 3948 \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to 3949 %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}% 3950 \splittopskip = \topskip 3951 % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint. 3952 {% 3953 \vbadness = 10000 3954 \loop 3955 \global\setbox3 = \copy0 3956 \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@ 3957 \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@ 3958 \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt 3959 \repeat 3960 }% 3961 %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}% 3962 \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}% 3963 \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}% 3964 % 3965 \pagesofar 3966 } 3967 \catcode`\@ = \other 3968 3969 3970 \message{sectioning,} 3971 % Chapters, sections, etc. 3972 3973 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered 3974 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf 3975 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter 3976 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000 3977 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.) 3978 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000 3979 \newcount\chapno 3980 \newcount\secno \secno=0 3981 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0 3982 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0 3983 3984 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ... 3985 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@ 3986 % 3987 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno} 3988 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple 3989 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual 3990 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset. 3991 % 3992 \def\appendixletter{% 3993 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A% 3994 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B% 3995 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C% 3996 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D% 3997 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E% 3998 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F% 3999 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G% 4000 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H% 4001 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I% 4002 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J% 4003 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K% 4004 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L% 4005 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M% 4006 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N% 4007 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O% 4008 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P% 4009 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q% 4010 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R% 4011 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S% 4012 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T% 4013 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U% 4014 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V% 4015 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W% 4016 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X% 4017 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y% 4018 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z% 4019 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is 4020 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not 4021 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out 4022 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it. 4023 \else\char\the\appendixno 4024 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi 4025 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi} 4026 4027 % Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter. 4028 % page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise. 4029 % However, they are not reliable, because we don't use marks. 4030 \def\thischapter{} 4031 \def\thissection{} 4032 4033 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level 4034 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count 4035 4036 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc. 4037 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1} 4038 \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name 4039 4040 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc. 4041 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1} 4042 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name 4043 4044 % we only have subsub. 4045 \chardef\maxseclevel = 3 4046 % 4047 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too. 4048 % To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in: 4049 \chardef\unmlevel = \maxseclevel 4050 % 4051 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not: 4052 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored. 4053 \def\chapheadtype{N} 4054 4055 % Choose a heading macro 4056 % #1 is heading type 4057 % #2 is heading level 4058 % #3 is text for heading 4059 \def\genhead#1#2#3{% 4060 % Compute the abs. sec. level: 4061 \absseclevel=#2 4062 \advance\absseclevel by \secbase 4063 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range: 4064 \ifnum \absseclevel < 0 4065 \absseclevel = 0 4066 \else 4067 \ifnum \absseclevel > 3 4068 \absseclevel = 3 4069 \fi 4070 \fi 4071 % The heading type: 4072 \def\headtype{#1}% 4073 \if \headtype U% 4074 \ifnum \absseclevel < \unmlevel 4075 \chardef\unmlevel = \absseclevel 4076 \fi 4077 \else 4078 % Check for appendix sections: 4079 \ifnum \absseclevel = 0 4080 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}% 4081 \else 4082 \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N% 4083 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}% 4084 \fi\fi 4085 \fi 4086 % Check for numbered within unnumbered: 4087 \ifnum \absseclevel > \unmlevel 4088 \def\headtype{U}% 4089 \else 4090 \chardef\unmlevel = 3 4091 \fi 4092 \fi 4093 % Now print the heading: 4094 \if \headtype U% 4095 \ifcase\absseclevel 4096 \unnumberedzzz{#3}% 4097 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}% 4098 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}% 4099 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}% 4100 \fi 4101 \else 4102 \if \headtype A% 4103 \ifcase\absseclevel 4104 \appendixzzz{#3}% 4105 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}% 4106 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}% 4107 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}% 4108 \fi 4109 \else 4110 \ifcase\absseclevel 4111 \chapterzzz{#3}% 4112 \or \seczzz{#3}% 4113 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}% 4114 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}% 4115 \fi 4116 \fi 4117 \fi 4118 \suppressfirstparagraphindent 4119 } 4120 4121 % an interface: 4122 \def\numhead{\genhead N} 4123 \def\apphead{\genhead A} 4124 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U} 4125 4126 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset 4127 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero. 4128 % 4129 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers 4130 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty. 4131 \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty 4132 % 4133 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz 4134 \def\chapterzzz#1{% 4135 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such 4136 % as an @include file. 4137 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 4138 \global\advance\chapno by 1 4139 % 4140 % Used for \float. 4141 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}% 4142 \resetallfloatnos 4143 % 4144 \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}% 4145 % 4146 % Write the actual heading. 4147 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}% 4148 % 4149 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter. 4150 \global\let\section = \numberedsec 4151 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec 4152 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec 4153 } 4154 4155 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz 4156 \def\appendixzzz#1{% 4157 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 4158 \global\advance\appendixno by 1 4159 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}% 4160 \resetallfloatnos 4161 % 4162 \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}% 4163 \message{\appendixnum}% 4164 % 4165 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}% 4166 % 4167 \global\let\section = \appendixsec 4168 \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec 4169 \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec 4170 } 4171 4172 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz 4173 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{% 4174 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 4175 \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1 4176 % 4177 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures. 4178 \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty 4179 \resetallfloatnos 4180 % 4181 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the 4182 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX 4183 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX 4184 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant 4185 % to be executed, not expanded). 4186 % 4187 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear 4188 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use 4189 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once, 4190 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for 4191 % the toc entries.) 4192 \toks0 = {#1}% 4193 \message{(\the\toks0)}% 4194 % 4195 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}% 4196 % 4197 \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec 4198 \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec 4199 \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec 4200 } 4201 4202 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered. 4203 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{% 4204 % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break 4205 % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level. 4206 % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04 4207 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters 4208 \unnmhead0{#1}% 4209 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax 4210 } 4211 4212 % @top is like @unnumbered. 4213 \let\top\unnumbered 4214 4215 % Sections. 4216 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz 4217 \def\seczzz#1{% 4218 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 4219 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}% 4220 } 4221 4222 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz 4223 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{% 4224 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 4225 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}% 4226 } 4227 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection 4228 4229 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz 4230 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{% 4231 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 4232 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}% 4233 } 4234 4235 % Subsections. 4236 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz 4237 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{% 4238 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 4239 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% 4240 } 4241 4242 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz 4243 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{% 4244 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 4245 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}% 4246 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% 4247 } 4248 4249 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz 4250 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{% 4251 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 4252 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}% 4253 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% 4254 } 4255 4256 % Subsubsections. 4257 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz 4258 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{% 4259 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 4260 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}% 4261 {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% 4262 } 4263 4264 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz 4265 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{% 4266 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 4267 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}% 4268 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% 4269 } 4270 4271 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz 4272 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{% 4273 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 4274 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}% 4275 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% 4276 } 4277 4278 % These macros control what the section commands do, according 4279 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered). 4280 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter. 4281 \let\section = \numberedsec 4282 \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec 4283 \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec 4284 4285 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading 4286 4287 % NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such: 4288 % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit 4289 % overlong headings to fold. 4290 % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a 4291 % heading is obnoxious; this forbids it. 4292 % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and 4293 % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright. 4294 4295 4296 \def\majorheading{% 4297 {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }% 4298 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz 4299 } 4300 4301 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz} 4302 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{% 4303 {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 4304 \parindent=0pt\raggedright 4305 \rm #1\hfill}}% 4306 \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax 4307 \suppressfirstparagraphindent 4308 } 4309 4310 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading. 4311 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} 4312 \suppressfirstparagraphindent} 4313 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} 4314 \suppressfirstparagraphindent} 4315 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} 4316 \suppressfirstparagraphindent} 4317 4318 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only 4319 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it), 4320 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form. 4321 4322 %%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative) 4323 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi} 4324 4325 %%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it 4326 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed) 4327 4328 \newskip\chapheadingskip 4329 4330 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}} 4331 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject} 4332 \def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to 0pt{} \chappager\fi} 4333 4334 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname} 4335 4336 \def\CHAPPAGoff{% 4337 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager 4338 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak 4339 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager} 4340 4341 \def\CHAPPAGon{% 4342 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager 4343 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager 4344 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager 4345 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}} 4346 4347 \def\CHAPPAGodd{% 4348 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage 4349 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage 4350 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage 4351 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}} 4352 4353 \CHAPPAGon 4354 4355 % Chapter opening. 4356 % 4357 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, 4358 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number. 4359 % 4360 % To test against our argument. 4361 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing} 4362 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc} 4363 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix} 4364 % 4365 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{% 4366 \pchapsepmacro 4367 {% 4368 \chapfonts \rm 4369 % 4370 % Have to define \thissection before calling \donoderef, because the 4371 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called 4372 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon. 4373 \gdef\thissection{#1}% 4374 \gdef\thischaptername{#1}% 4375 % 4376 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix 4377 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''. 4378 \def\temptype{#2}% 4379 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword 4380 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% 4381 \def\toctype{unnchap}% 4382 \gdef\thischapter{#1}% 4383 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword 4384 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry 4385 \def\toctype{omit}% 4386 \gdef\thischapter{}% 4387 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword 4388 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}% 4389 \def\toctype{app}% 4390 % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter 4391 % because we don't want its macros evaluated now. And we don't 4392 % use \thissection because that changes with each section. 4393 % 4394 \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter: 4395 \noexpand\thischaptername}% 4396 \else 4397 \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}% 4398 \def\toctype{numchap}% 4399 \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno: 4400 \noexpand\thischaptername}% 4401 \fi\fi\fi 4402 % 4403 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the 4404 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc 4405 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty. 4406 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}% 4407 % 4408 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make 4409 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has 4410 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the 4411 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not 4412 % being visible, for instance under high magnification. 4413 \donoderef{#2}% 4414 % 4415 % Typeset the actual heading. 4416 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright 4417 \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe 4418 \unhbox0 #1\par}% 4419 }% 4420 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title 4421 \nobreak 4422 } 4423 4424 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered. 4425 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax 4426 \def\centerparameters{% 4427 \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip 4428 \leftskip = \rightskip 4429 \parfillskip = 0pt 4430 } 4431 4432 4433 % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not 4434 % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03. 4435 % 4436 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname} 4437 % 4438 \def\unnchfopen #1{% 4439 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 4440 \parindent=0pt\raggedright 4441 \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak 4442 } 4443 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts 4444 \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}% 4445 \par\penalty 5000 % 4446 } 4447 \def\centerchfopen #1{% 4448 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 4449 \parindent=0pt 4450 \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak 4451 } 4452 \def\CHAPFopen{% 4453 \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen 4454 \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen} 4455 4456 4457 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and 4458 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing. 4459 % 4460 \newskip\secheadingskip 4461 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}} 4462 4463 % Subsection titles. 4464 \newskip\subsecheadingskip 4465 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}} 4466 4467 % Subsubsection titles. 4468 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip} 4469 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak} 4470 4471 4472 % Print any size, any type, section title. 4473 % 4474 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is 4475 % the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the 4476 % section number. 4477 % 4478 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{% 4479 {% 4480 % Switch to the right set of fonts. 4481 \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm 4482 % 4483 % Insert space above the heading. 4484 \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname 4485 % 4486 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number. 4487 \def\sectionlevel{#2}% 4488 \def\temptype{#3}% 4489 % 4490 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword 4491 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% 4492 \def\toctype{unn}% 4493 \gdef\thissection{#1}% 4494 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword 4495 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc, 4496 % and don't redefine \thissection. 4497 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% 4498 \def\toctype{omit}% 4499 \let\sectionlevel=\empty 4500 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword 4501 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% 4502 \def\toctype{app}% 4503 \gdef\thissection{#1}% 4504 \else 4505 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% 4506 \def\toctype{num}% 4507 \gdef\thissection{#1}% 4508 \fi\fi\fi 4509 % 4510 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro. 4511 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}% 4512 % 4513 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex). 4514 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro. 4515 \donoderef{#3}% 4516 % 4517 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed. 4518 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be 4519 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the 4520 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that 4521 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the 4522 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000. 4523 \nobreak 4524 % 4525 % Output the actual section heading. 4526 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright 4527 \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number 4528 \unhbox0 #1}% 4529 }% 4530 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it. 4531 % Don't allow stretch, though. 4532 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname 4533 % 4534 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it 4535 % was followed by glue. 4536 \nobreak 4537 % 4538 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that 4539 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a 4540 % discardable item.) 4541 \vskip-\parskip 4542 % 4543 % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty > 4544 % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after 4545 % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between: 4546 % 4547 % @section sec-whatever 4548 % @deffn def-whatever 4549 \penalty 10001 4550 } 4551 4552 4553 \message{toc,} 4554 % Table of contents. 4555 \newwrite\tocfile 4556 4557 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary. 4558 % Called from @chapter, etc. 4559 % 4560 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno} 4561 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional 4562 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually 4563 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the 4564 % destination to jump to. 4565 % 4566 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or 4567 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document. 4568 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the 4569 % table of contents chapter openings themselves. 4570 % 4571 \newif\iftocfileopened 4572 \def\omitkeyword{omit}% 4573 % 4574 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{% 4575 \edef\writetoctype{#1}% 4576 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else 4577 \iftocfileopened\else 4578 \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc 4579 \global\tocfileopenedtrue 4580 \fi 4581 % 4582 \iflinks 4583 {\atdummies 4584 \edef\temp{% 4585 \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}% 4586 \temp 4587 }% 4588 \fi 4589 \fi 4590 % 4591 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're 4592 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't 4593 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered 4594 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first 4595 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named 4596 % `1', and two named `2'. 4597 \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi 4598 } 4599 4600 4601 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman 4602 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant 4603 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file. 4604 % 4605 \def\activecatcodes{% 4606 \catcode`\"=\active 4607 \catcode`\$=\active 4608 \catcode`\<=\active 4609 \catcode`\>=\active 4610 \catcode`\\=\active 4611 \catcode`\^=\active 4612 \catcode`\_=\active 4613 \catcode`\|=\active 4614 \catcode`\~=\active 4615 } 4616 4617 4618 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input. 4619 \def\readtocfile{% 4620 \setupdatafile 4621 \activecatcodes 4622 \input \jobname.toc 4623 } 4624 4625 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in 4626 \newcount\savepageno 4627 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1 4628 4629 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile. 4630 % 4631 \def\startcontents#1{% 4632 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should 4633 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain 4634 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro. 4635 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege (a] matematik.su.se> 4636 \contentsalignmacro 4637 \immediate\closeout\tocfile 4638 % 4639 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline. 4640 % It is abundantly clear what they are. 4641 \def\thischapter{}% 4642 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}% 4643 % 4644 \savepageno = \pageno 4645 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly. 4646 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom. 4647 \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length. 4648 % 4649 % Roman numerals for page numbers. 4650 \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi 4651 } 4652 4653 4654 % Normal (long) toc. 4655 \def\contents{% 4656 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}% 4657 \openin 1 \jobname.toc 4658 \ifeof 1 \else 4659 \readtocfile 4660 \fi 4661 \vfill \eject 4662 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect 4663 \ifeof 1 \else 4664 \pdfmakeoutlines 4665 \fi 4666 \closein 1 4667 \endgroup 4668 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno 4669 \global\pageno = \savepageno 4670 } 4671 4672 % And just the chapters. 4673 \def\summarycontents{% 4674 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}% 4675 % 4676 \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry 4677 \let\appentry = \shortchapentry 4678 \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry 4679 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers. 4680 \secfonts 4681 \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf 4682 \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt 4683 \rm 4684 \hyphenpenalty = 10000 4685 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little. 4686 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{} 4687 \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry 4688 \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry 4689 \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry 4690 \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry 4691 \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry 4692 \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry 4693 \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry 4694 \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry 4695 \openin 1 \jobname.toc 4696 \ifeof 1 \else 4697 \readtocfile 4698 \fi 4699 \closein 1 4700 \vfill \eject 4701 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect 4702 \endgroup 4703 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno 4704 \global\pageno = \savepageno 4705 } 4706 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents 4707 4708 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents. 4709 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter. 4710 % 4711 \def\shortchaplabel#1{% 4712 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the 4713 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts. 4714 % But use \hss just in case. 4715 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after 4716 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.) 4717 % 4718 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange 4719 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and 4720 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10 4721 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters 4722 % there are before deciding ... 4723 \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}% 4724 } 4725 4726 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents. 4727 % The first argument is the chapter or section name. 4728 % The last argument is the page number. 4729 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ... 4730 4731 % Chapters, in the main contents. 4732 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} 4733 % 4734 % Chapters, in the short toc. 4735 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings. 4736 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{% 4737 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}% 4738 } 4739 4740 % Appendices, in the main contents. 4741 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box. 4742 % 4743 \def\appendixbox#1{% 4744 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter. 4745 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}% 4746 \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}} 4747 % 4748 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}} 4749 4750 % Unnumbered chapters. 4751 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}} 4752 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}} 4753 4754 % Sections. 4755 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} 4756 \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry 4757 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}} 4758 4759 % Subsections. 4760 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} 4761 \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry 4762 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}} 4763 4764 % And subsubsections. 4765 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} 4766 \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry 4767 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}} 4768 4769 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels. 4770 % Same as \defaultparindent. 4771 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt 4772 4773 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the 4774 % page number. 4775 % 4776 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters 4777 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty. 4778 \def\dochapentry#1#2{% 4779 \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip 4780 \begingroup 4781 \chapentryfonts 4782 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% 4783 \endgroup 4784 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip 4785 } 4786 4787 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup 4788 \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent 4789 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% 4790 \endgroup} 4791 4792 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup 4793 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent 4794 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% 4795 \endgroup} 4796 4797 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup 4798 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent 4799 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% 4800 \endgroup} 4801 4802 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries. 4803 \let\tocentry = \entry 4804 4805 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title. 4806 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax} 4807 4808 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}} 4809 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}} 4810 4811 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm} 4812 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts} 4813 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts} 4814 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts} 4815 4816 4817 \message{environments,} 4818 % @foo ... @end foo. 4819 4820 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}. 4821 % 4822 % Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of 4823 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em. 4824 % 4825 \def\point{$\star$} 4826 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}} 4827 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}} 4828 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}} 4829 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}} 4830 4831 % The @error{} command. 4832 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit. 4833 % 4834 \newbox\errorbox 4835 % 4836 {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box. 4837 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules 4838 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.) 4839 \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \tensf error\kern-1.5pt} 4840 % 4841 \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil 4842 \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right. 4843 \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules. 4844 \vbox{% 4845 \hrule height\dimen2 4846 \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text. 4847 \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below. 4848 \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right. 4849 \hrule height\dimen2} 4850 \hfil} 4851 % 4852 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox} 4853 4854 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily. 4855 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works. 4856 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character. 4857 4858 \envdef\tex{% 4859 \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2 4860 \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6 4861 \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie 4862 \catcode `\%=14 4863 \catcode `\+=\other 4864 \catcode `\"=\other 4865 \catcode `\|=\other 4866 \catcode `\<=\other 4867 \catcode `\>=\other 4868 \escapechar=`\\ 4869 % 4870 \let\b=\ptexb 4871 \let\bullet=\ptexbullet 4872 \let\c=\ptexc 4873 \let\,=\ptexcomma 4874 \let\.=\ptexdot 4875 \let\dots=\ptexdots 4876 \let\equiv=\ptexequiv 4877 \let\!=\ptexexclam 4878 \let\i=\ptexi 4879 \let\indent=\ptexindent 4880 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent 4881 \let\{=\ptexlbrace 4882 \let\+=\tabalign 4883 \let\}=\ptexrbrace 4884 \let\/=\ptexslash 4885 \let\*=\ptexstar 4886 \let\t=\ptext 4887 \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing 4888 % 4889 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}% 4890 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}% 4891 \def\@{@}% 4892 } 4893 % There is no need to define \Etex. 4894 4895 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp. 4896 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things, 4897 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous). 4898 4899 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp. 4900 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in 4901 4902 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other 4903 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't 4904 % have any width. 4905 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf} 4906 4907 % This space is always present above and below environments. 4908 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt 4909 4910 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here 4911 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip 4912 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the 4913 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip. 4914 % 4915 \def\aboveenvbreak{{% 4916 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and 4917 % \sectionheading, q.v. 4918 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else 4919 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip 4920 \endgraf 4921 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount 4922 \removelastskip 4923 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak 4924 % or better ... 4925 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi 4926 \vskip\envskipamount 4927 \fi 4928 \fi 4929 }} 4930 4931 \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak 4932 4933 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will 4934 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again. 4935 \let\nonarrowing=\relax 4936 4937 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around 4938 % environment contents. 4939 \font\circle=lcircle10 4940 \newdimen\circthick 4941 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner 4942 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip 4943 \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle 4944 % 4945 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth 4946 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}} 4947 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}} 4948 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}} 4949 \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip 4950 \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr 4951 \hskip\rskip}} 4952 \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip 4953 \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr 4954 \hskip\rskip}} 4955 % 4956 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip 4957 4958 \envdef\cartouche{% 4959 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph. 4960 \startsavinginserts 4961 \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip 4962 \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*. 4963 \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip 4964 \advance\cartinner by-\rskip 4965 \cartouter=\hsize 4966 \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either 4967 % side, and for 6pt waste from 4968 % each corner char, and rule thickness 4969 \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip 4970 % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin. 4971 \let\nonarrowing = t% 4972 \vbox\bgroup 4973 \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt 4974 \carttop 4975 \hbox\bgroup 4976 \hskip\lskip 4977 \vrule\kern3pt 4978 \vbox\bgroup 4979 \kern3pt 4980 \hsize=\cartinner 4981 \baselineskip=\normbskip 4982 \lineskip=\normlskip 4983 \parskip=\normpskip 4984 \vskip -\parskip 4985 \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group. 4986 } 4987 \def\Ecartouche{% 4988 \ifhmode\par\fi 4989 \kern3pt 4990 \egroup 4991 \kern3pt\vrule 4992 \hskip\rskip 4993 \egroup 4994 \cartbot 4995 \egroup 4996 \checkinserts 4997 } 4998 4999 5000 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants, 5001 % inside a group. 5002 \def\nonfillstart{% 5003 \aboveenvbreak 5004 \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy 5005 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens. 5006 \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines 5007 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output 5008 \parskip = 0pt 5009 \parindent = 0pt 5010 \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes 5011 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax 5012 \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing 5013 \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing 5014 \else 5015 \let\nonarrowing = \relax 5016 \fi 5017 \let\exdent=\nofillexdent 5018 } 5019 5020 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small. 5021 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall. 5022 % This affects the following displayed environments: 5023 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp 5024 % 5025 \def\smallword{small} 5026 \def\nosmallword{nosmall} 5027 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax 5028 \def\setnormaldispenv{% 5029 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword 5030 \smallexamplefonts \rm 5031 \fi 5032 } 5033 \def\setsmalldispenv{% 5034 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword 5035 \else 5036 \smallexamplefonts \rm 5037 \fi 5038 } 5039 5040 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo. 5041 % Let's do it by one command: 5042 \def\makedispenv #1#2{ 5043 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2} 5044 \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2} 5045 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak 5046 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak 5047 } 5048 5049 % Define two synonyms: 5050 \def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{ 5051 \makedispenv{#1}{#3} 5052 \makedispenv{#2}{#3} 5053 } 5054 5055 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp. 5056 % 5057 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts. 5058 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox. 5059 % 5060 \maketwodispenvs {lisp}{example}{% 5061 \nonfillstart 5062 \tt 5063 \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special. 5064 \gobble % eat return 5065 } 5066 5067 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font. 5068 % 5069 \makedispenv {display}{% 5070 \nonfillstart 5071 \gobble 5072 } 5073 5074 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins. 5075 % 5076 \makedispenv{format}{% 5077 \let\nonarrowing = t% 5078 \nonfillstart 5079 \gobble 5080 } 5081 5082 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize. 5083 \envdef\flushleft{% 5084 \let\nonarrowing = t% 5085 \nonfillstart 5086 \gobble 5087 } 5088 \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak 5089 5090 % @flushright. 5091 % 5092 \envdef\flushright{% 5093 \let\nonarrowing = t% 5094 \nonfillstart 5095 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill 5096 \gobble 5097 } 5098 \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak 5099 5100 5101 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart) 5102 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since 5103 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and 5104 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0. 5105 % 5106 \envdef\quotation{% 5107 {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip 5108 \parindent=0pt 5109 % 5110 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down. 5111 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax 5112 \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing 5113 \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing 5114 \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing 5115 \else 5116 \let\nonarrowing = \relax 5117 \fi 5118 \parsearg\quotationlabel 5119 } 5120 5121 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're 5122 % doing normal filling. 5123 % 5124 \def\Equotation{% 5125 \par 5126 \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else 5127 % indent a bit. 5128 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}% 5129 \fi 5130 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}% 5131 } 5132 5133 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after. 5134 \def\quotationlabel#1{% 5135 \def\temp{#1}% 5136 \ifx\temp\empty \else 5137 {\bf #1: }% 5138 \fi 5139 } 5140 5141 5142 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>} 5143 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter, 5144 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg: 5145 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke (a] gnu.org 5146 % 5147 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook. 5148 % 5149 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets 5150 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a 5151 % verbatim line. 5152 \def\dospecials{% 5153 \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&% 5154 \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~% 5155 \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"% 5156 } 5157 % 5158 % [Knuth] p. 380 5159 \def\uncatcodespecials{% 5160 \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials} 5161 % 5162 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391 5163 % Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font 5164 \begingroup 5165 \catcode`\`=\active\gdef`{\relax\lq} 5166 \endgroup 5167 % 5168 % Setup for the @verb command. 5169 % 5170 % Eight spaces for a tab 5171 \begingroup 5172 \catcode`\^^I=\active 5173 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }} 5174 \endgroup 5175 % 5176 \def\setupverb{% 5177 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim 5178 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}% 5179 \catcode`\`=\active 5180 \tabeightspaces 5181 % Respect line breaks, 5182 % print special symbols as themselves, and 5183 % make each space count 5184 % must do in this order: 5185 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces 5186 } 5187 5188 % Setup for the @verbatim environment 5189 % 5190 % Real tab expansion 5191 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount 5192 % 5193 \def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup} 5194 \begingroup 5195 \catcode`\^^I=\active 5196 \gdef\tabexpand{% 5197 \catcode`\^^I=\active 5198 \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup 5199 \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab 5200 \divide\dimen0 by\tabw 5201 \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw 5202 \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw 5203 \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox 5204 }% 5205 } 5206 \endgroup 5207 \def\setupverbatim{% 5208 \let\nonarrowing = t% 5209 \nonfillstart 5210 % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim 5211 \tt 5212 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}% 5213 \catcode`\`=\active 5214 \tabexpand 5215 % Respect line breaks, 5216 % print special symbols as themselves, and 5217 % make each space count 5218 % must do in this order: 5219 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces 5220 \everypar{\starttabbox}% 5221 } 5222 5223 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique 5224 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a 5225 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace: 5226 % 5227 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1} 5228 % 5229 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {} 5230 \begingroup 5231 \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other 5232 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next] 5233 \endgroup 5234 % 5235 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb} 5236 % 5237 % 5238 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that 5239 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie: 5240 % 5241 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1} 5242 % 5243 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX, 5244 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}': 5245 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'. 5246 % 5247 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx] 5248 % 5249 \begingroup 5250 \catcode`\ =\active 5251 \obeylines % 5252 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end 5253 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank 5254 % line in the output. 5255 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}% 5256 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but 5257 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble. 5258 \endgroup 5259 % 5260 \envdef\verbatim{% 5261 \setupverbatim\doverbatim 5262 } 5263 \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak 5264 5265 5266 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment. 5267 % 5268 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude} 5269 % 5270 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{% 5271 {% 5272 \makevalueexpandable 5273 \setupverbatim 5274 \input #1 5275 \afterenvbreak 5276 }% 5277 } 5278 5279 % @copying ... @end copying. 5280 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later. 5281 % 5282 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box. 5283 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the 5284 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done 5285 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source 5286 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as 5287 % possible is very desirable. 5288 % 5289 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying} 5290 \def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}} 5291 % 5292 \def\insertcopying{% 5293 \begingroup 5294 \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page 5295 \scanexp\copyingtext 5296 \endgroup 5297 } 5298 5299 \message{defuns,} 5300 % @defun etc. 5301 5302 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in 5303 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt 5304 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt 5305 5306 % Start the processing of @deffn: 5307 \def\startdefun{% 5308 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 5309 \medbreak 5310 \else 5311 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak, 5312 % which is there to keep the function description together with its 5313 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a 5314 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted 5315 % by \defargscommonending, instead of 10000, since the sectioning 5316 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow 5317 % a break between a section heading and a defun. 5318 % 5319 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \fi 5320 % 5321 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break. 5322 % But do insert the glue. 5323 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint 5324 \fi 5325 % 5326 \parindent=0in 5327 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent 5328 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent 5329 } 5330 5331 \def\dodefunx#1{% 5332 % First, check whether we are in the right environment: 5333 \checkenv#1% 5334 % 5335 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row. 5336 % It's not a great place, though. 5337 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \fi 5338 % 5339 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun: 5340 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1% 5341 } 5342 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{} 5343 5344 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text} 5345 % 5346 \def\printdefunline#1#2{% 5347 \begingroup 5348 % call \deffnheader: 5349 #1#2 \endheader 5350 % common ending: 5351 \interlinepenalty = 10000 5352 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil 5353 \endgraf 5354 \nobreak\vskip -\parskip 5355 \penalty 10002 % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx 5356 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses, 5357 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize. 5358 \checkparencounts 5359 \endgroup 5360 } 5361 5362 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak} 5363 5364 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn; 5365 % the only thing remainnig is to define \deffnheader. 5366 % 5367 \def\makedefun#1{% 5368 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun 5369 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun 5370 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}% 5371 \temp 5372 } 5373 5374 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader 5375 % 5376 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters. 5377 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly. 5378 % 5379 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{% 5380 \envdef#1{% 5381 \startdefun 5382 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}% 5383 }% 5384 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}% 5385 \def#3% 5386 } 5387 5388 %%% Untyped functions: 5389 5390 % @deffn category name args 5391 \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}} 5392 5393 % @deffn category class name args 5394 \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}} 5395 5396 % \defopon {category on}class name args 5397 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } 5398 5399 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args 5400 % 5401 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{% 5402 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}. 5403 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}% 5404 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}% 5405 } 5406 5407 %%% Typed functions: 5408 5409 % @deftypefn category type name args 5410 \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}} 5411 5412 % @deftypeop category class type name args 5413 \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}} 5414 5415 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args 5416 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } 5417 5418 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args 5419 % 5420 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{% 5421 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}% 5422 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}% 5423 } 5424 5425 %%% Typed variables: 5426 5427 % @deftypevr category type var args 5428 \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}} 5429 5430 % @deftypecv category class type var args 5431 \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}} 5432 5433 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args 5434 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } 5435 5436 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args 5437 % 5438 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{% 5439 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}% 5440 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}% 5441 } 5442 5443 %%% Untyped variables: 5444 5445 % @defvr category var args 5446 \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} } 5447 5448 % @defcv category class var args 5449 \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}} 5450 5451 % \defcvof {category of}class var args 5452 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} } 5453 5454 %%% Type: 5455 % @deftp category name args 5456 \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{% 5457 \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}% 5458 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}% 5459 } 5460 5461 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts: 5462 \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} } 5463 \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} } 5464 \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} } 5465 \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} } 5466 \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} } 5467 \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} } 5468 \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} } 5469 \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon} 5470 \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon} 5471 \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof} 5472 \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof} 5473 5474 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args). 5475 % #1 is the category, such as "Function". 5476 % #2 is the return type, if any. 5477 % #3 is the function name. 5478 % 5479 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any. 5480 % 5481 \def\defname#1#2#3{% 5482 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def... 5483 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent 5484 % 5485 % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps 5486 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line 5487 % just below it. 5488 \def\temp{#1}% 5489 \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi} 5490 % 5491 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. 5492 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero, 5493 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it: 5494 \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip 5495 % The continuations: 5496 \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent 5497 % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.) 5498 \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2 5499 % 5500 % Put the type name to the right margin. 5501 \noindent 5502 \hbox to 0pt{% 5503 \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize 5504 % \hsize has to be shortened this way: 5505 \kern\leftskip 5506 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space. 5507 }% 5508 % 5509 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint: 5510 \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000 5511 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent 5512 {% 5513 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because: 5514 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle. 5515 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's 5516 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in 5517 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm. 5518 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures. 5519 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no 5520 % one has made identifiers using them :). 5521 \df \tt 5522 \def\temp{#2}% return value type 5523 \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi 5524 #3% output function name 5525 }% 5526 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm 5527 % 5528 \boldbrax 5529 % arguments will be output next, if any. 5530 } 5531 5532 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using 5533 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in 5534 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very 5535 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars. 5536 % 5537 \def\defunargs#1{% 5538 % use sl by default (not ttsl), 5539 % tt for the names. 5540 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0 5541 % 5542 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we 5543 % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that. 5544 \let\var=\ttslanted 5545 #1% 5546 \sl\hyphenchar\font=45 5547 } 5548 5549 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line. 5550 % 5551 \def\activeparens{% 5552 \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active 5553 \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active 5554 \catcode`\&=\active 5555 } 5556 5557 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars. 5558 \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = ) 5559 5560 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example, 5561 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet, 5562 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence. 5563 { 5564 \activeparens 5565 \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen 5566 \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack 5567 \global\let& = \& 5568 5569 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb} 5570 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm} 5571 } 5572 5573 \newcount\parencount 5574 5575 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards 5576 \newif\ifampseen 5577 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\ }} 5578 5579 \def\parenfont{% 5580 \ifampseen 5581 % At the first level, print parens in roman, 5582 % otherwise use the default font. 5583 \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi 5584 \else 5585 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than 5586 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] . 5587 \sf 5588 \fi 5589 } 5590 \def\infirstlevel#1{% 5591 \ifampseen 5592 \ifnum\parencount=1 5593 #1% 5594 \fi 5595 \fi 5596 } 5597 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf} 5598 5599 \def\opnr{% 5600 \global\advance\parencount by 1 5601 {\parenfont(}% 5602 \infirstlevel \bfafterword 5603 } 5604 \def\clnr{% 5605 {\parenfont)}% 5606 \infirstlevel \sl 5607 \global\advance\parencount by -1 5608 } 5609 5610 \newcount\brackcount 5611 \def\lbrb{% 5612 \global\advance\brackcount by 1 5613 {\bf[}% 5614 } 5615 \def\rbrb{% 5616 {\bf]}% 5617 \global\advance\brackcount by -1 5618 } 5619 5620 \def\checkparencounts{% 5621 \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi 5622 \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi 5623 } 5624 \def\badparencount{% 5625 \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}% 5626 \global\parencount=0 5627 } 5628 \def\badbrackcount{% 5629 \errmessage{Unbalanced square braces in @def}% 5630 \global\brackcount=0 5631 } 5632 5633 5634 \message{macros,} 5635 % @macro. 5636 5637 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens, 5638 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX. 5639 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined 5640 \newwrite\macscribble 5641 \def\scantokens#1{% 5642 \toks0={#1}% 5643 \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp 5644 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}% 5645 \immediate\closeout\macscribble 5646 \input \jobname.tmp 5647 } 5648 \fi 5649 5650 \def\scanmacro#1{% 5651 \begingroup 5652 \newlinechar`\^^M 5653 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces 5654 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex 5655 % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active 5656 % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had 5657 % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears 5658 % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04 5659 \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@ 5660 % ... and \example 5661 \spaceisspace 5662 % 5663 % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline. 5664 % 5665 % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX 5666 % --kasal, 29nov03 5667 \scantokens{#1\endinput}% 5668 \endgroup 5669 } 5670 5671 \def\scanexp#1{% 5672 \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}% 5673 \temp 5674 } 5675 5676 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters 5677 \newtoks\macname % Macro name 5678 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive? 5679 5680 % List of all defined macros in the form 5681 % \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2... 5682 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split 5683 % if there is a need. 5684 \def\macrolist{} 5685 5686 % Add the macro to \macrolist 5687 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname} 5688 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{% 5689 \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}% 5690 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}% 5691 } 5692 5693 % Utility routines. 5694 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is, 5695 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname 5696 % (except of course we have to play expansion games). 5697 % 5698 \def\cslet#1#2{% 5699 \expandafter\let 5700 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname 5701 \csname#2\endcsname 5702 } 5703 5704 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string. 5705 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN). 5706 {\catcode`\@=11 5707 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }} 5708 \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@} 5709 \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @} 5710 \def\unbrace#1{#1} 5711 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1} 5712 } 5713 5714 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string. 5715 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3% 5716 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}% 5717 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}% 5718 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}% 5719 } 5720 5721 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where 5722 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active 5723 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \. 5724 5725 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is 5726 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro 5727 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro. 5728 5729 \def\scanctxt{% 5730 \catcode`\"=\other 5731 \catcode`\+=\other 5732 \catcode`\<=\other 5733 \catcode`\>=\other 5734 \catcode`\@=\other 5735 \catcode`\^=\other 5736 \catcode`\_=\other 5737 \catcode`\|=\other 5738 \catcode`\~=\other 5739 } 5740 5741 \def\scanargctxt{% 5742 \scanctxt 5743 \catcode`\\=\other 5744 \catcode`\^^M=\other 5745 } 5746 5747 \def\macrobodyctxt{% 5748 \scanctxt 5749 \catcode`\{=\other 5750 \catcode`\}=\other 5751 \catcode`\^^M=\other 5752 \usembodybackslash 5753 } 5754 5755 \def\macroargctxt{% 5756 \scanctxt 5757 \catcode`\\=\other 5758 } 5759 5760 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies. 5761 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N 5762 % where N is the macro parameter number. 5763 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so 5764 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash. 5765 5766 {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active 5767 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash} 5768 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname} 5769 } 5770 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash} 5771 5772 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx} 5773 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx} 5774 5775 \def\macroxxx#1{% 5776 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist 5777 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments 5778 \paramno=0% 5779 \else 5780 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;% 5781 \fi 5782 \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname 5783 \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}% 5784 \else 5785 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax 5786 \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi 5787 \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}% 5788 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1% 5789 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}% 5790 \fi 5791 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt 5792 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody 5793 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody 5794 \fi} 5795 5796 \parseargdef\unmacro{% 5797 \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname 5798 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}% 5799 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0% 5800 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist: 5801 \begingroup 5802 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax 5803 \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo 5804 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}% 5805 \endgroup 5806 \else 5807 \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}% 5808 \fi 5809 } 5810 5811 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any 5812 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax. 5813 % 5814 \def\unmacrodo#1{% 5815 \ifx #1\relax 5816 % remove this 5817 \else 5818 \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1% 5819 \fi 5820 } 5821 5822 % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a 5823 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by 5824 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed. 5825 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}} 5826 \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs} 5827 \def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}} 5828 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}} 5829 5830 % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist 5831 % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah 5832 % in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list. 5833 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above). 5834 5835 % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions. 5836 % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something 5837 % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine 5838 % it to # just before using the token list produced. 5839 % 5840 % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before 5841 % the macro is used. 5842 5843 \def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}% 5844 \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,} 5845 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{% 5846 \if#1;\let\next=\relax 5847 \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx 5848 \advance\paramno by 1% 5849 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname 5850 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}% 5851 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}% 5852 \fi\next} 5853 5854 % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. 5855 % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.) 5856 5857 \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro% 5858 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% 5859 \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro% 5860 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% 5861 5862 % This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and 5863 % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments. 5864 % Much magic with \expandafter here. 5865 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file 5866 % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group. 5867 \def\defmacro{% 5868 \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars 5869 \ifrecursive 5870 \ifcase\paramno 5871 % 0 5872 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% 5873 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% 5874 \or % 1 5875 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% 5876 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt 5877 \noexpand\braceorline 5878 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% 5879 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% 5880 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% 5881 \else % many 5882 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% 5883 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt 5884 \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% 5885 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% 5886 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% 5887 \expandafter\expandafter 5888 \expandafter\xdef 5889 \expandafter\expandafter 5890 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname 5891 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% 5892 \fi 5893 \else 5894 \ifcase\paramno 5895 % 0 5896 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% 5897 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% 5898 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% 5899 \or % 1 5900 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% 5901 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt 5902 \noexpand\braceorline 5903 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% 5904 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% 5905 \egroup 5906 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% 5907 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% 5908 \else % many 5909 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% 5910 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt 5911 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% 5912 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% 5913 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% 5914 \expandafter\expandafter 5915 \expandafter\xdef 5916 \expandafter\expandafter 5917 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname 5918 \paramlist{% 5919 \egroup 5920 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% 5921 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% 5922 \fi 5923 \fi} 5924 5925 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}} 5926 5927 % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a 5928 % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole 5929 % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence 5930 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg) 5931 \def\braceorline#1{\let\next=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx} 5932 \def\braceorlinexxx{% 5933 \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else 5934 \expandafter\parsearg 5935 \fi \next} 5936 5937 5938 % @alias. 5939 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal 5940 % sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing. 5941 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx} 5942 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax} 5943 \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{% 5944 {% 5945 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty 5946 \addtomacrolist{#1}% 5947 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}% 5948 }% 5949 \next 5950 } 5951 5952 5953 \message{cross references,} 5954 5955 \newwrite\auxfile 5956 5957 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known. 5958 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known. 5959 5960 % @inforef is relatively simple. 5961 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**} 5962 \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}}, 5963 node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}} 5964 5965 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in 5966 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and 5967 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like: 5968 % @node foo , bar , ... 5969 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name. 5970 % 5971 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse} 5972 % 5973 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this: 5974 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs 5975 \def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse} 5976 \def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}} 5977 5978 \let\nwnode=\node 5979 \let\lastnode=\empty 5980 5981 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the 5982 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing). 5983 % 5984 \def\donoderef#1{% 5985 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else 5986 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}% 5987 \global\let\lastnode=\empty 5988 \fi 5989 } 5990 5991 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point. 5992 % 5993 \newcount\savesfregister 5994 % 5995 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi} 5996 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi} 5997 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces} 5998 5999 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an 6000 % anchor), which consists of three parts: 6001 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \thissection, 6002 % or the anchor name. 6003 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or 6004 % empty for anchors. 6005 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number. 6006 % 6007 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of 6008 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here: 6009 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats. 6010 % 6011 \def\setref#1#2{% 6012 \pdfmkdest{#1}% 6013 \iflinks 6014 {% 6015 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them 6016 \edef\writexrdef##1##2{% 6017 \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef 6018 ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef 6019 }% 6020 \toks0 = \expandafter{\thissection}% 6021 \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }% 6022 \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc. 6023 \writexrdef{pg}{\folio}% will be written later, during \shipout 6024 }% 6025 \fi 6026 } 6027 6028 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is 6029 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed 6030 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed 6031 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted. 6032 % 6033 \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} 6034 \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} 6035 \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} 6036 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup 6037 \unsepspaces 6038 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}% 6039 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}% 6040 \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}% 6041 \setbox0=\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}% 6042 \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt 6043 % No printed node name was explicitly given. 6044 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax 6045 % Use the node name inside the square brackets. 6046 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% 6047 \else 6048 % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside 6049 % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it. 6050 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt 6051 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it. 6052 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% 6053 \else 6054 \ifhavexrefs 6055 % We know the real title if we have the xref values. 6056 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}% 6057 \else 6058 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name. 6059 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% 6060 \fi% 6061 \fi 6062 \fi 6063 \fi 6064 % 6065 % Make link in pdf output. 6066 \ifpdf 6067 \leavevmode 6068 \getfilename{#4}% 6069 {\turnoffactive 6070 % See comments at \activebackslashdouble. 6071 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfxrefdest{#1}% 6072 \backslashparens\pdfxrefdest}% 6073 % 6074 \ifnum\filenamelength>0 6075 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% 6076 goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}% 6077 \else 6078 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% 6079 goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}% 6080 \fi 6081 }% 6082 \linkcolor 6083 \fi 6084 % 6085 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2" 6086 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the 6087 % LABEL-title being set to a magic string. 6088 {% 6089 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to 6090 % include an _ in the xref name, etc. 6091 \indexnofonts 6092 \turnoffactive 6093 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle 6094 \csname XR#1-title\endcsname 6095 }% 6096 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle 6097 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref, 6098 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2". 6099 \ifdim\wd0 = 0pt 6100 \refx{#1-snt}{}% 6101 \else 6102 \printedrefname 6103 \fi 6104 % 6105 % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append 6106 % "in MANUALNAME". 6107 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt 6108 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}% 6109 \fi 6110 \else 6111 % node/anchor (non-float) references. 6112 % 6113 % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not 6114 % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will 6115 % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals 6116 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this 6117 % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it 6118 % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time. 6119 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt 6120 \putwordsection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}% 6121 \else 6122 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the 6123 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand 6124 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of 6125 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the 6126 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg. 6127 {\turnoffactive 6128 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for 6129 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be. 6130 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}% 6131 \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi 6132 }% 6133 % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden. 6134 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname 6135 % 6136 % But we always want a comma and a space: 6137 ,\space 6138 % 6139 % output the `page 3'. 6140 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}% 6141 \fi 6142 \fi 6143 \endlink 6144 \endgroup} 6145 6146 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref 6147 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily, 6148 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly 6149 % one that Bob is working on :). 6150 % 6151 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]} 6152 6153 % Things referred to by \setref. 6154 % 6155 \def\Ynothing{} 6156 \def\Yomitfromtoc{} 6157 \def\Ynumbered{% 6158 \ifnum\secno=0 6159 \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno 6160 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 6161 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno 6162 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 6163 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno 6164 \else 6165 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno 6166 \fi\fi\fi 6167 } 6168 \def\Yappendix{% 6169 \ifnum\secno=0 6170 \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}% 6171 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 6172 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno 6173 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 6174 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno 6175 \else 6176 \putwordSection@tie 6177 @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno 6178 \fi\fi\fi 6179 } 6180 6181 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME. 6182 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward. 6183 % 6184 \def\refx#1#2{% 6185 {% 6186 \indexnofonts 6187 \otherbackslash 6188 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX 6189 \csname XR#1\endcsname 6190 }% 6191 \ifx\thisrefX\relax 6192 % If not defined, say something at least. 6193 \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright 6194 \iflinks 6195 \ifhavexrefs 6196 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}% 6197 \else 6198 \ifwarnedxrefs\else 6199 \global\warnedxrefstrue 6200 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}% 6201 \fi 6202 \fi 6203 \fi 6204 \else 6205 % It's defined, so just use it. 6206 \thisrefX 6207 \fi 6208 #2% Output the suffix in any case. 6209 } 6210 6211 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's 6212 % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid 6213 % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do. 6214 % 6215 \def\xrdef#1#2{% 6216 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR#1\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref value. 6217 % 6218 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float? 6219 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR#1\endcsname 6220 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype. 6221 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist 6222 \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname 6223 % 6224 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type? 6225 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax 6226 \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do 6227 \else 6228 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list. 6229 \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}% 6230 \fi 6231 % 6232 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE, 6233 % for later use in \listoffloats. 6234 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0{#1}}% 6235 \fi 6236 } 6237 6238 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists. 6239 % 6240 \def\tryauxfile{% 6241 \openin 1 \jobname.aux 6242 \ifeof 1 \else 6243 \readdatafile{aux}% 6244 \global\havexrefstrue 6245 \fi 6246 \closein 1 6247 } 6248 6249 \def\setupdatafile{% 6250 \catcode`\^^@=\other 6251 \catcode`\^^A=\other 6252 \catcode`\^^B=\other 6253 \catcode`\^^C=\other 6254 \catcode`\^^D=\other 6255 \catcode`\^^E=\other 6256 \catcode`\^^F=\other 6257 \catcode`\^^G=\other 6258 \catcode`\^^H=\other 6259 \catcode`\^^K=\other 6260 \catcode`\^^L=\other 6261 \catcode`\^^N=\other 6262 \catcode`\^^P=\other 6263 \catcode`\^^Q=\other 6264 \catcode`\^^R=\other 6265 \catcode`\^^S=\other 6266 \catcode`\^^T=\other 6267 \catcode`\^^U=\other 6268 \catcode`\^^V=\other 6269 \catcode`\^^W=\other 6270 \catcode`\^^X=\other 6271 \catcode`\^^Z=\other 6272 \catcode`\^^[=\other 6273 \catcode`\^^\=\other 6274 \catcode`\^^]=\other 6275 \catcode`\^^^=\other 6276 \catcode`\^^_=\other 6277 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc. 6278 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't 6279 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore, 6280 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^ 6281 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat 6282 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first 6283 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could 6284 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't. 6285 % 6286 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat: 6287 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter 6288 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq. 6289 % 6290 \catcode`\^=\other 6291 % 6292 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but... 6293 \catcode`\~=\other 6294 \catcode`\[=\other 6295 \catcode`\]=\other 6296 \catcode`\"=\other 6297 \catcode`\_=\other 6298 \catcode`\|=\other 6299 \catcode`\<=\other 6300 \catcode`\>=\other 6301 \catcode`\$=\other 6302 \catcode`\#=\other 6303 \catcode`\&=\other 6304 \catcode`\%=\other 6305 \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off 6306 % 6307 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \ 6308 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than 6309 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \ 6310 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value* 6311 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that 6312 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for 6313 % now. --karl, 15jan04. 6314 \catcode`\\=\other 6315 % 6316 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters. 6317 {% 6318 \count1=128 6319 \def\loop{% 6320 \catcode\count1=\other 6321 \advance\count1 by 1 6322 \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi 6323 }% 6324 }% 6325 % 6326 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces. 6327 \catcode`\{=1 6328 \catcode`\}=2 6329 \catcode`\@=0 6330 } 6331 6332 \def\readdatafile#1{% 6333 \begingroup 6334 \setupdatafile 6335 \input\jobname.#1 6336 \endgroup} 6337 6338 \message{insertions,} 6339 % including footnotes. 6340 6341 \newcount \footnoteno 6342 6343 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is 6344 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a 6345 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is 6346 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a 6347 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.) 6348 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 } 6349 6350 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only. 6351 \let\footnotestyle=\comment 6352 6353 {\catcode `\@=11 6354 % 6355 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain. 6356 \gdef\footnote{% 6357 \let\indent=\ptexindent 6358 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent 6359 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne 6360 \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}% 6361 % 6362 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the 6363 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number. 6364 \let\@sf\empty 6365 \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi 6366 % 6367 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number. 6368 \unskip 6369 \thisfootno\@sf 6370 \dofootnote 6371 }% 6372 6373 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the 6374 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general. 6375 % 6376 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses 6377 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when 6378 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96. 6379 % 6380 \gdef\dofootnote{% 6381 \insert\footins\bgroup 6382 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the 6383 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment. 6384 % So reset some parameters. 6385 \hsize=\pagewidth 6386 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty 6387 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes 6388 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox 6389 \floatingpenalty\@MM 6390 \leftskip\z@skip 6391 \rightskip\z@skip 6392 \spaceskip\z@skip 6393 \xspaceskip\z@skip 6394 \parindent\defaultparindent 6395 % 6396 \smallfonts \rm 6397 % 6398 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears 6399 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use 6400 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote 6401 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style). 6402 \let\noindent = \relax 6403 % 6404 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the 6405 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph. 6406 \everypar = {\hang}% 6407 \textindent{\thisfootno}% 6408 % 6409 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this 6410 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it 6411 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote. 6412 \footstrut 6413 \futurelet\next\fo@t 6414 } 6415 }%end \catcode `\@=11 6416 6417 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create 6418 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion 6419 % would be lost. 6420 % Similarily, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote 6421 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished. 6422 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03. 6423 6424 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro. 6425 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled 6426 % out prematurely. 6427 % 6428 \def\startsavinginserts{% 6429 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert 6430 \let\insert\saveinsert 6431 \else 6432 \let\checkinserts\relax 6433 \fi 6434 } 6435 6436 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and 6437 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}. 6438 % 6439 \def\saveinsert#1{% 6440 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}% 6441 \afterassignment\next 6442 % swallow the left brace 6443 \let\temp = 6444 } 6445 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}} 6446 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1} 6447 6448 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi} 6449 6450 \def\placesaveins#1{% 6451 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname 6452 {\box#1}% 6453 } 6454 6455 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other: 6456 { 6457 \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-) 6458 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{} 6459 } 6460 6461 % initialization: 6462 \def\newsaveins #1{% 6463 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}% 6464 \next 6465 } 6466 \def\newsaveinsX #1{% 6467 \csname newbox\endcsname #1% 6468 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts 6469 \checksaveins #1}% 6470 } 6471 6472 % initialize: 6473 \let\checkinserts\empty 6474 \newsaveins\footins 6475 \newsaveins\margin 6476 6477 6478 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this. 6479 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain. 6480 % 6481 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image 6482 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get 6483 % undone and the next image would fail. 6484 \openin 1 = epsf.tex 6485 \ifeof 1 \else 6486 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in 6487 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan). 6488 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }% 6489 \input epsf.tex 6490 \fi 6491 \closein 1 6492 % 6493 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex. 6494 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf 6495 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to 6496 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get 6497 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.} 6498 % 6499 \def\image#1{% 6500 \ifx\epsfbox\undefined 6501 \ifwarnednoepsf \else 6502 \errhelp = \noepsfhelp 6503 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}% 6504 \global\warnednoepsftrue 6505 \fi 6506 \else 6507 \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish 6508 \fi 6509 } 6510 % 6511 % Arguments to @image: 6512 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension. 6513 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height. 6514 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text. 6515 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension. 6516 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff. 6517 \newif\ifimagevmode 6518 \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup 6519 \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example 6520 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names 6521 % If the image is by itself, center it. 6522 \ifvmode 6523 \imagevmodetrue 6524 \nobreak\bigskip 6525 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert 6526 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space 6527 % above and below. 6528 \nobreak\vskip\parskip 6529 \nobreak 6530 \line\bgroup 6531 \fi 6532 % 6533 % Output the image. 6534 \ifpdf 6535 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}% 6536 \else 6537 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure. 6538 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi 6539 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi 6540 \epsfbox{#1.eps}% 6541 \fi 6542 % 6543 \ifimagevmode \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image 6544 \endgroup} 6545 6546 6547 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables, 6548 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the 6549 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future. 6550 % 6551 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish} 6552 6553 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it. 6554 \def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,} 6555 6556 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically 6557 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted, 6558 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to. 6559 % 6560 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to 6561 % be referable. 6562 % 6563 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It 6564 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom). 6565 % 6566 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each 6567 % chapter-level command. 6568 \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty 6569 % 6570 \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% 6571 \let\thiscaption=\empty 6572 \let\thisshortcaption=\empty 6573 % 6574 % don't lose footnotes inside @float. 6575 % 6576 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an 6577 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04 6578 % 6579 \startsavinginserts 6580 % 6581 % We can't be used inside a paragraph. 6582 \par 6583 % 6584 \vtop\bgroup 6585 \def\floattype{#1}% 6586 \def\floatlabel{#2}% 6587 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet. 6588 % 6589 \ifx\floattype\empty 6590 \let\safefloattype=\empty 6591 \else 6592 {% 6593 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters, 6594 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name. 6595 \indexnofonts 6596 \turnoffactive 6597 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}% 6598 }% 6599 \fi 6600 % 6601 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type. 6602 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else 6603 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1, 6604 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.) 6605 % 6606 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname 6607 \global\advance\floatno by 1 6608 % 6609 {% 6610 % This magic value for \thissection is output by \setref as the 6611 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float 6612 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from 6613 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the 6614 % lists of floats. 6615 % 6616 \edef\thissection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}% 6617 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}% 6618 }% 6619 \fi 6620 % 6621 % start with \parskip glue, I guess. 6622 \vskip\parskip 6623 % 6624 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section. 6625 \restorefirstparagraphindent 6626 } 6627 6628 % we have these possibilities: 6629 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap 6630 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1 6631 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap 6632 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo 6633 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap 6634 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1 6635 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap 6636 % @float & no caption: 6637 % 6638 \def\Efloat{% 6639 \let\floatident = \empty 6640 % 6641 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first. 6642 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi 6643 % 6644 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next. 6645 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else 6646 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first. 6647 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}% 6648 \fi 6649 % the number. 6650 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}% 6651 \fi 6652 % 6653 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in 6654 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again. 6655 \let\captionline = \floatident 6656 % 6657 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else 6658 \ifx\floatident\empty \else 6659 \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between 6660 \fi 6661 % 6662 % caption text. 6663 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}% 6664 \fi 6665 % 6666 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before. 6667 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert. 6668 \ifx\captionline\empty \else 6669 \vskip.5\parskip 6670 \captionline 6671 % 6672 % Space below caption. 6673 \vskip\parskip 6674 \fi 6675 % 6676 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this 6677 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint. 6678 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else 6679 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as 6680 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short 6681 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing. 6682 {% 6683 \atdummies 6684 % 6685 % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M 6686 % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so 6687 % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file. 6688 \scanexp{% 6689 \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{% 6690 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty 6691 \thiscaption 6692 \else 6693 \thisshortcaption 6694 \fi 6695 }% 6696 }% 6697 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident 6698 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}% 6699 }% 6700 \fi 6701 \egroup % end of \vtop 6702 % 6703 % place the captured inserts 6704 % 6705 % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning 6706 % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly 6707 % float. --kasal, 26may04 6708 % 6709 \checkinserts 6710 } 6711 6712 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either. 6713 % 6714 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{% 6715 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}% 6716 } 6717 6718 % @caption, @shortcaption 6719 % 6720 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption} 6721 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption} 6722 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption} 6723 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}} 6724 6725 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are 6726 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno. 6727 \def\getfloatno#1{% 6728 \ifx#1\relax 6729 % Haven't seen this figure type before. 6730 \csname newcount\endcsname #1% 6731 % 6732 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap. 6733 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos 6734 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }% 6735 \fi 6736 \let\floatno#1% 6737 } 6738 6739 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref 6740 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we 6741 % first read the @float command. 6742 % 6743 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}% 6744 6745 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can 6746 % distinguish floats from other xref types. 6747 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!} 6748 6749 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional 6750 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic 6751 % \thissection value which we \setref above. 6752 % 6753 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish} 6754 % 6755 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the 6756 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2. 6757 % 6758 \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{% 6759 \def\temp{#1}% 6760 \def\iffloattype{#2}% 6761 \ifx\temp\floatmagic 6762 } 6763 6764 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents. 6765 % 6766 \parseargdef\listoffloats{% 6767 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype 6768 {% 6769 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters, 6770 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name. 6771 \indexnofonts 6772 \turnoffactive 6773 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}% 6774 }% 6775 % 6776 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE. 6777 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax 6778 \ifhavexrefs 6779 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo. 6780 \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}% 6781 \fi 6782 \else 6783 \begingroup 6784 \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc 6785 \let\do=\listoffloatsdo 6786 \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname 6787 \endgroup 6788 \fi 6789 } 6790 6791 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the 6792 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the 6793 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which 6794 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here. 6795 % 6796 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since 6797 % they won't appear in the aux file). 6798 % 6799 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish} 6800 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{% 6801 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just 6802 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the 6803 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link 6804 % in pdf output. 6805 \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}% 6806 % 6807 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index. 6808 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}% 6809 \writeentry 6810 }} 6811 6812 \message{localization,} 6813 % and i18n. 6814 6815 % @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after 6816 % @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything 6817 % properly. Single argument is the language abbreviation. 6818 % It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file here. 6819 % 6820 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{% 6821 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX. 6822 % Read the file if it exists. 6823 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex 6824 \ifeof 1 6825 \errhelp = \nolanghelp 6826 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}% 6827 \else 6828 \input txi-#1.tex 6829 \fi 6830 \closein 1 6831 \endgroup 6832 } 6833 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or 6834 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory 6835 should work if nowhere else does.} 6836 6837 6838 % @documentencoding should change something in TeX eventually, most 6839 % likely, but for now just recognize it. 6840 \let\documentencoding = \comment 6841 6842 6843 % Page size parameters. 6844 % 6845 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt 6846 6847 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt 6848 \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt 6849 \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt 6850 6851 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages. 6852 \vbadness = 10000 6853 6854 % Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either. 6855 \hbadness = 2000 6856 6857 % Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans. 6858 \widowpenalty=10000 6859 \clubpenalty=10000 6860 6861 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're 6862 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of 6863 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on 6864 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set. 6865 % 6866 \def\setemergencystretch{% 6867 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined 6868 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway. 6869 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}% 6870 \else 6871 \emergencystretch = .15\hsize 6872 \fi 6873 } 6874 6875 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth; 6876 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip; 6877 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width. 6878 % 6879 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define 6880 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip. 6881 % 6882 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{% 6883 \voffset = #3\relax 6884 \topskip = #6\relax 6885 \splittopskip = \topskip 6886 % 6887 \vsize = #1\relax 6888 \advance\vsize by \topskip 6889 \outervsize = \vsize 6890 \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin 6891 \pageheight = \vsize 6892 % 6893 \hsize = #2\relax 6894 \outerhsize = \hsize 6895 \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in 6896 \pagewidth = \hsize 6897 % 6898 \normaloffset = #4\relax 6899 \bindingoffset = #5\relax 6900 % 6901 \ifpdf 6902 \pdfpageheight #7\relax 6903 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax 6904 \fi 6905 % 6906 \setleading{\textleading} 6907 % 6908 \parindent = \defaultparindent 6909 \setemergencystretch 6910 } 6911 6912 % @letterpaper (the default). 6913 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 6914 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt 6915 \textleading = 13.2pt 6916 % 6917 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even. 6918 \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}% 6919 {\voffset}{.25in}% 6920 {\bindingoffset}{36pt}% 6921 {11in}{8.5in}% 6922 }} 6923 6924 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size. 6925 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1 6926 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt 6927 \textleading = 12pt 6928 % 6929 \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}% 6930 {\voffset}{.25in}% 6931 {\bindingoffset}{16pt}% 6932 {9.25in}{7in}% 6933 % 6934 \lispnarrowing = 0.3in 6935 \tolerance = 700 6936 \hfuzz = 1pt 6937 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt 6938 \defbodyindent = .5cm 6939 }} 6940 6941 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size. 6942 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.) 6943 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1 6944 \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt 6945 \textleading = 12pt 6946 % 6947 \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}% 6948 {-.2in}{-.4in}% 6949 {0pt}{14pt}% 6950 {9in}{6in}% 6951 % 6952 \lispnarrowing = 0.25in 6953 \tolerance = 700 6954 \hfuzz = 1pt 6955 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt 6956 \defbodyindent = .4cm 6957 }} 6958 6959 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper. 6960 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 6961 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt 6962 \textleading = 13.2pt 6963 % 6964 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050 6965 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm. 6966 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust 6967 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then 6968 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in 6969 % your texinfo source file like this: 6970 % @tex 6971 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm 6972 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm 6973 % @end tex 6974 \internalpagesizes{51\baselineskip}{160mm} 6975 {\voffset}{\hoffset}% 6976 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% 6977 {297mm}{210mm}% 6978 % 6979 \tolerance = 700 6980 \hfuzz = 1pt 6981 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt 6982 \defbodyindent = 5mm 6983 }} 6984 6985 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper. 6986 % From romildo (a] urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000. 6987 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small. 6988 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1 6989 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt 6990 \textleading = 12.5pt 6991 % 6992 \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}% 6993 {\voffset}{\hoffset}% 6994 {\bindingoffset}{8pt}% 6995 {210mm}{148mm}% 6996 % 6997 \lispnarrowing = 0.2in 6998 \tolerance = 800 6999 \hfuzz = 1.2pt 7000 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt 7001 \defbodyindent = 2mm 7002 \tableindent = 12mm 7003 }} 7004 7005 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper. 7006 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1 7007 \afourpaper 7008 \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}% 7009 {\voffset}{4.6mm}% 7010 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% 7011 {297mm}{210mm}% 7012 % 7013 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper. 7014 \globaldefs = 0 7015 }} 7016 7017 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format. 7018 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1 7019 \afourpaper 7020 \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}% 7021 {\voffset}{-2.95mm}% 7022 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% 7023 {297mm}{210mm}% 7024 \globaldefs = 0 7025 }} 7026 7027 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH] 7028 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip, 7029 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow. 7030 % 7031 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish} 7032 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{% 7033 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi 7034 \globaldefs = 1 7035 % 7036 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt 7037 \setleading{\textleading}% 7038 % 7039 \dimen0 = #1 7040 \advance\dimen0 by \voffset 7041 % 7042 \dimen2 = \hsize 7043 \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset 7044 % 7045 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}% 7046 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}% 7047 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% 7048 {\dimen0}{\dimen2}% 7049 }} 7050 7051 % Set default to letter. 7052 % 7053 \letterpaper 7054 7055 7056 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.} 7057 7058 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text. 7059 \catcode`\"=\other 7060 \catcode`\~=\other 7061 \catcode`\^=\other 7062 \catcode`\_=\other 7063 \catcode`\|=\other 7064 \catcode`\<=\other 7065 \catcode`\>=\other 7066 \catcode`\+=\other 7067 \catcode`\$=\other 7068 \def\normaldoublequote{"} 7069 \def\normaltilde{~} 7070 \def\normalcaret{^} 7071 \def\normalunderscore{_} 7072 \def\normalverticalbar{|} 7073 \def\normalless{<} 7074 \def\normalgreater{>} 7075 \def\normalplus{+} 7076 \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix 7077 7078 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt 7079 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts, 7080 % where something hairier probably needs to be done. 7081 % 7082 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print 7083 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero 7084 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all 7085 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter. 7086 % 7087 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi} 7088 7089 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches 7090 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from 7091 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway 7092 % this is not a problem. 7093 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi} 7094 7095 % Turn off all special characters except @ 7096 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary). 7097 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can 7098 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text. 7099 7100 \catcode`\"=\active 7101 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}} 7102 \let"=\activedoublequote 7103 \catcode`\~=\active 7104 \def~{{\tt\char126}} 7105 \chardef\hat=`\^ 7106 \catcode`\^=\active 7107 \def^{{\tt \hat}} 7108 7109 \catcode`\_=\active 7110 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_} 7111 \let\realunder=_ 7112 % Subroutine for the previous macro. 7113 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em } 7114 7115 \catcode`\|=\active 7116 \def|{{\tt\char124}} 7117 \chardef \less=`\< 7118 \catcode`\<=\active 7119 \def<{{\tt \less}} 7120 \chardef \gtr=`\> 7121 \catcode`\>=\active 7122 \def>{{\tt \gtr}} 7123 \catcode`\+=\active 7124 \def+{{\tt \char 43}} 7125 \catcode`\$=\active 7126 \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix 7127 7128 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file 7129 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line. 7130 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on. 7131 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file. 7132 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other} 7133 7134 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after 7135 % parsing them. 7136 \def\turnoffactive{% 7137 \normalturnoffactive 7138 \otherbackslash 7139 } 7140 7141 \catcode`\@=0 7142 7143 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font, 7144 % as in \char`\\. 7145 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\ 7146 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work 7147 7148 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and 7149 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines). 7150 {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}} 7151 7152 % In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash 7153 % in fixed width font. 7154 \catcode`\\=\active 7155 @def@normalbackslash{{@tt@backslashcurfont}} 7156 % On startup, @fixbackslash assigns: 7157 % @let \ = @normalbackslash 7158 7159 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont. 7160 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with 7161 % catcode other. 7162 @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont} 7163 @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash} 7164 7165 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of 7166 % the literal character `\'. 7167 % 7168 @def@normalturnoffactive{% 7169 @let\=@normalbackslash 7170 @let"=@normaldoublequote 7171 @let~=@normaltilde 7172 @let^=@normalcaret 7173 @let_=@normalunderscore 7174 @let|=@normalverticalbar 7175 @let<=@normalless 7176 @let>=@normalgreater 7177 @let+=@normalplus 7178 @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix 7179 @unsepspaces 7180 } 7181 7182 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily. 7183 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash. 7184 @otherifyactive 7185 7186 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up. 7187 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing 7188 % a backslash. 7189 % 7190 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash} 7191 @global@let\ = @eatinput 7192 7193 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then 7194 % the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix 7195 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur. 7196 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input 7197 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format. 7198 % 7199 @gdef@fixbackslash{% 7200 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi 7201 @catcode`+=@active 7202 @catcode`@_=@active 7203 } 7204 7205 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages. 7206 @escapechar = `@@ 7207 7208 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special. 7209 @catcode`@& = @other 7210 @catcode`@# = @other 7211 @catcode`@% = @other 7212 7213 7214 @c Local variables: 7215 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) 7216 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message" 7217 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{" 7218 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" 7219 @c time-stamp-end: "}" 7220 @c End: 7221 7222 @c vim:sw=2: 7223 7224 @ignore 7225 arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115 7226 @end ignore 7227